xref: /openbmc/linux/include/uapi/linux/nl80211.h (revision da60fbe7)
1 #ifndef __LINUX_NL80211_H
2 #define __LINUX_NL80211_H
3 /*
4  * 802.11 netlink interface public header
5  *
6  * Copyright 2006-2010 Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net>
7  * Copyright 2008 Michael Wu <flamingice@sourmilk.net>
8  * Copyright 2008 Luis Carlos Cobo <luisca@cozybit.com>
9  * Copyright 2008 Michael Buesch <m@bues.ch>
10  * Copyright 2008, 2009 Luis R. Rodriguez <lrodriguez@atheros.com>
11  * Copyright 2008 Jouni Malinen <jouni.malinen@atheros.com>
12  * Copyright 2008 Colin McCabe <colin@cozybit.com>
13  * Copyright 2015-2017	Intel Deutschland GmbH
14  * Copyright (C) 2018-2019 Intel Corporation
15  *
16  * Permission to use, copy, modify, and/or distribute this software for any
17  * purpose with or without fee is hereby granted, provided that the above
18  * copyright notice and this permission notice appear in all copies.
19  *
20  * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS" AND THE AUTHOR DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES
21  * WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
22  * MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR BE LIABLE FOR
23  * ANY SPECIAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
24  * WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN AN
25  * ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING OUT OF
26  * OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
27  *
28  */
29 
30 /*
31  * This header file defines the userspace API to the wireless stack. Please
32  * be careful not to break things - i.e. don't move anything around or so
33  * unless you can demonstrate that it breaks neither API nor ABI.
34  *
35  * Additions to the API should be accompanied by actual implementations in
36  * an upstream driver, so that example implementations exist in case there
37  * are ever concerns about the precise semantics of the API or changes are
38  * needed, and to ensure that code for dead (no longer implemented) API
39  * can actually be identified and removed.
40  * Nonetheless, semantics should also be documented carefully in this file.
41  */
42 
43 #include <linux/types.h>
44 
45 #define NL80211_GENL_NAME "nl80211"
46 
47 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_CONFIG		"config"
48 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_SCAN		"scan"
49 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_REG		"regulatory"
50 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_MLME		"mlme"
51 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_VENDOR		"vendor"
52 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_NAN		"nan"
53 #define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_TESTMODE	"testmode"
54 
55 #define NL80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_MIN	4
56 #define NL80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_MAX	15
57 #define NL80211_EDMG_CHANNELS_MIN	1
58 #define NL80211_EDMG_CHANNELS_MAX	0x3c /* 0b00111100 */
59 
60 /**
61  * DOC: Station handling
62  *
63  * Stations are added per interface, but a special case exists with VLAN
64  * interfaces. When a station is bound to an AP interface, it may be moved
65  * into a VLAN identified by a VLAN interface index (%NL80211_ATTR_STA_VLAN).
66  * The station is still assumed to belong to the AP interface it was added
67  * to.
68  *
69  * Station handling varies per interface type and depending on the driver's
70  * capabilities.
71  *
72  * For drivers supporting TDLS with external setup (WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_TDLS
73  * and WIPHY_FLAG_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP), the station lifetime is as follows:
74  *  - a setup station entry is added, not yet authorized, without any rate
75  *    or capability information, this just exists to avoid race conditions
76  *  - when the TDLS setup is done, a single NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION is valid
77  *    to add rate and capability information to the station and at the same
78  *    time mark it authorized.
79  *  - %NL80211_TDLS_ENABLE_LINK is then used
80  *  - after this, the only valid operation is to remove it by tearing down
81  *    the TDLS link (%NL80211_TDLS_DISABLE_LINK)
82  *
83  * TODO: need more info for other interface types
84  */
85 
86 /**
87  * DOC: Frame transmission/registration support
88  *
89  * Frame transmission and registration support exists to allow userspace
90  * management entities such as wpa_supplicant react to management frames
91  * that are not being handled by the kernel. This includes, for example,
92  * certain classes of action frames that cannot be handled in the kernel
93  * for various reasons.
94  *
95  * Frame registration is done on a per-interface basis and registrations
96  * cannot be removed other than by closing the socket. It is possible to
97  * specify a registration filter to register, for example, only for a
98  * certain type of action frame. In particular with action frames, those
99  * that userspace registers for will not be returned as unhandled by the
100  * driver, so that the registered application has to take responsibility
101  * for doing that.
102  *
103  * The type of frame that can be registered for is also dependent on the
104  * driver and interface type. The frame types are advertised in wiphy
105  * attributes so applications know what to expect.
106  *
107  * NOTE: When an interface changes type while registrations are active,
108  *       these registrations are ignored until the interface type is
109  *       changed again. This means that changing the interface type can
110  *       lead to a situation that couldn't otherwise be produced, but
111  *       any such registrations will be dormant in the sense that they
112  *       will not be serviced, i.e. they will not receive any frames.
113  *
114  * Frame transmission allows userspace to send for example the required
115  * responses to action frames. It is subject to some sanity checking,
116  * but many frames can be transmitted. When a frame was transmitted, its
117  * status is indicated to the sending socket.
118  *
119  * For more technical details, see the corresponding command descriptions
120  * below.
121  */
122 
123 /**
124  * DOC: Virtual interface / concurrency capabilities
125  *
126  * Some devices are able to operate with virtual MACs, they can have
127  * more than one virtual interface. The capability handling for this
128  * is a bit complex though, as there may be a number of restrictions
129  * on the types of concurrency that are supported.
130  *
131  * To start with, each device supports the interface types listed in
132  * the %NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_IFTYPES attribute, but by listing the
133  * types there no concurrency is implied.
134  *
135  * Once concurrency is desired, more attributes must be observed:
136  * To start with, since some interface types are purely managed in
137  * software, like the AP-VLAN type in mac80211 for example, there's
138  * an additional list of these, they can be added at any time and
139  * are only restricted by some semantic restrictions (e.g. AP-VLAN
140  * cannot be added without a corresponding AP interface). This list
141  * is exported in the %NL80211_ATTR_SOFTWARE_IFTYPES attribute.
142  *
143  * Further, the list of supported combinations is exported. This is
144  * in the %NL80211_ATTR_INTERFACE_COMBINATIONS attribute. Basically,
145  * it exports a list of "groups", and at any point in time the
146  * interfaces that are currently active must fall into any one of
147  * the advertised groups. Within each group, there are restrictions
148  * on the number of interfaces of different types that are supported
149  * and also the number of different channels, along with potentially
150  * some other restrictions. See &enum nl80211_if_combination_attrs.
151  *
152  * All together, these attributes define the concurrency of virtual
153  * interfaces that a given device supports.
154  */
155 
156 /**
157  * DOC: packet coalesce support
158  *
159  * In most cases, host that receives IPv4 and IPv6 multicast/broadcast
160  * packets does not do anything with these packets. Therefore the
161  * reception of these unwanted packets causes unnecessary processing
162  * and power consumption.
163  *
164  * Packet coalesce feature helps to reduce number of received interrupts
165  * to host by buffering these packets in firmware/hardware for some
166  * predefined time. Received interrupt will be generated when one of the
167  * following events occur.
168  * a) Expiration of hardware timer whose expiration time is set to maximum
169  * coalescing delay of matching coalesce rule.
170  * b) Coalescing buffer in hardware reaches it's limit.
171  * c) Packet doesn't match any of the configured coalesce rules.
172  *
173  * User needs to configure following parameters for creating a coalesce
174  * rule.
175  * a) Maximum coalescing delay
176  * b) List of packet patterns which needs to be matched
177  * c) Condition for coalescence. pattern 'match' or 'no match'
178  * Multiple such rules can be created.
179  */
180 
181 /**
182  * DOC: WPA/WPA2 EAPOL handshake offload
183  *
184  * By setting @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_PSK flag drivers
185  * can indicate they support offloading EAPOL handshakes for WPA/WPA2
186  * preshared key authentication. In %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT the preshared
187  * key should be specified using %NL80211_ATTR_PMK. Drivers supporting
188  * this offload may reject the %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT when no preshared
189  * key material is provided, for example when that driver does not
190  * support setting the temporal keys through %CMD_NEW_KEY.
191  *
192  * Similarly @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_1X flag can be
193  * set by drivers indicating offload support of the PTK/GTK EAPOL
194  * handshakes during 802.1X authentication. In order to use the offload
195  * the %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT should have %NL80211_ATTR_WANT_1X_4WAY_HS
196  * attribute flag. Drivers supporting this offload may reject the
197  * %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT when the attribute flag is not present.
198  *
199  * For 802.1X the PMK or PMK-R0 are set by providing %NL80211_ATTR_PMK
200  * using %NL80211_CMD_SET_PMK. For offloaded FT support also
201  * %NL80211_ATTR_PMKR0_NAME must be provided.
202  */
203 
204 /**
205  * DOC: FILS shared key authentication offload
206  *
207  * FILS shared key authentication offload can be advertized by drivers by
208  * setting @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_SK_OFFLOAD flag. The drivers that support
209  * FILS shared key authentication offload should be able to construct the
210  * authentication and association frames for FILS shared key authentication and
211  * eventually do a key derivation as per IEEE 802.11ai. The below additional
212  * parameters should be given to driver in %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT and/or in
213  * %NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_CONNECT_PARAMS.
214  *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_USERNAME - used to construct keyname_nai
215  *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_REALM - used to construct keyname_nai
216  *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_NEXT_SEQ_NUM - used to construct erp message
217  *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_RRK - used to generate the rIK and rMSK
218  * rIK should be used to generate an authentication tag on the ERP message and
219  * rMSK should be used to derive a PMKSA.
220  * rIK, rMSK should be generated and keyname_nai, sequence number should be used
221  * as specified in IETF RFC 6696.
222  *
223  * When FILS shared key authentication is completed, driver needs to provide the
224  * below additional parameters to userspace, which can be either after setting
225  * up a connection or after roaming.
226  *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_KEK - used for key renewal
227  *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_NEXT_SEQ_NUM - used in further EAP-RP exchanges
228  *	%NL80211_ATTR_PMKID - used to identify the PMKSA used/generated
229  *	%Nl80211_ATTR_PMK - used to update PMKSA cache in userspace
230  * The PMKSA can be maintained in userspace persistently so that it can be used
231  * later after reboots or wifi turn off/on also.
232  *
233  * %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID is the cache identifier advertized by a FILS
234  * capable AP supporting PMK caching. It specifies the scope within which the
235  * PMKSAs are cached in an ESS. %NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA and
236  * %NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMKSA are enhanced to allow support for PMKSA caching based
237  * on FILS cache identifier. Additionally %NL80211_ATTR_PMK is used with
238  * %NL80211_SET_PMKSA to specify the PMK corresponding to a PMKSA for driver to
239  * use in a FILS shared key connection with PMKSA caching.
240  */
241 
242 /**
243  * DOC: SAE authentication offload
244  *
245  * By setting @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SAE_OFFLOAD flag drivers can indicate they
246  * support offloading SAE authentication for WPA3-Personal networks. In
247  * %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT the password for SAE should be specified using
248  * %NL80211_ATTR_SAE_PASSWORD.
249  */
250 
251 /**
252  * DOC: VLAN offload support for setting group keys and binding STAs to VLANs
253  *
254  * By setting @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_VLAN_OFFLOAD flag drivers can indicate they
255  * support offloading VLAN functionality in a manner where the driver exposes a
256  * single netdev that uses VLAN tagged frames and separate VLAN-specific netdevs
257  * can then be added using RTM_NEWLINK/IFLA_VLAN_ID similarly to the Ethernet
258  * case. Frames received from stations that are not assigned to any VLAN are
259  * delivered on the main netdev and frames to such stations can be sent through
260  * that main netdev.
261  *
262  * %NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY (for group keys), %NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION, and
263  * %NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION will optionally specify vlan_id using
264  * %NL80211_ATTR_VLAN_ID.
265  */
266 
267 /**
268  * DOC: TID configuration
269  *
270  * TID config support can be checked in the %NL80211_ATTR_TID_CONFIG
271  * attribute given in wiphy capabilities.
272  *
273  * The necessary configuration parameters are mentioned in
274  * &enum nl80211_tid_config_attr and it will be passed to the
275  * %NL80211_CMD_SET_TID_CONFIG command in %NL80211_ATTR_TID_CONFIG.
276  *
277  * If the configuration needs to be applied for specific peer then the MAC
278  * address of the peer needs to be passed in %NL80211_ATTR_MAC, otherwise the
279  * configuration will be applied for all the connected peers in the vif except
280  * any peers that have peer specific configuration for the TID by default; if
281  * the %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_OVERRIDE flag is set, peer specific values
282  * will be overwritten.
283  *
284  * All this configuration is valid only for STA's current connection
285  * i.e. the configuration will be reset to default when the STA connects back
286  * after disconnection/roaming, and this configuration will be cleared when
287  * the interface goes down.
288  */
289 
290 /**
291  * enum nl80211_commands - supported nl80211 commands
292  *
293  * @NL80211_CMD_UNSPEC: unspecified command to catch errors
294  *
295  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY: request information about a wiphy or dump request
296  *	to get a list of all present wiphys.
297  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_WIPHY: set wiphy parameters, needs %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY or
298  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX; can be used to set %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_NAME,
299  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TXQ_PARAMS, %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ (and the
300  *	attributes determining the channel width; this is used for setting
301  *	monitor mode channel),  %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_SHORT,
302  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_LONG, %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FRAG_THRESHOLD,
303  *	and/or %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RTS_THRESHOLD.
304  *	However, for setting the channel, see %NL80211_CMD_SET_CHANNEL
305  *	instead, the support here is for backward compatibility only.
306  * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_WIPHY: Newly created wiphy, response to get request
307  *	or rename notification. Has attributes %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY and
308  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_NAME.
309  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_WIPHY: Wiphy deleted. Has attributes
310  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_NAME.
311  *
312  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_INTERFACE: Request an interface's configuration;
313  *	either a dump request for all interfaces or a specific get with a
314  *	single %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is supported.
315  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_INTERFACE: Set type of a virtual interface, requires
316  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX and %NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE.
317  * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_INTERFACE: Newly created virtual interface or response
318  *	to %NL80211_CMD_GET_INTERFACE. Has %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX,
319  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY and %NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE attributes. Can also
320  *	be sent from userspace to request creation of a new virtual interface,
321  *	then requires attributes %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY, %NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE and
322  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFNAME.
323  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_INTERFACE: Virtual interface was deleted, has attributes
324  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY. Can also be sent from
325  *	userspace to request deletion of a virtual interface, then requires
326  *	attribute %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
327  *
328  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_KEY: Get sequence counter information for a key specified
329  *	by %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX and/or %NL80211_ATTR_MAC.
330  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_KEY: Set key attributes %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT,
331  *	%NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT_MGMT, or %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_THRESHOLD.
332  * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY: add a key with given %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DATA,
333  *	%NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX, %NL80211_ATTR_MAC, %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_CIPHER,
334  *	and %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_SEQ attributes.
335  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_KEY: delete a key identified by %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX
336  *	or %NL80211_ATTR_MAC.
337  *
338  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_BEACON: (not used)
339  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON: change the beacon on an access point interface
340  *	using the %NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_HEAD and %NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_TAIL
341  *	attributes. For drivers that generate the beacon and probe responses
342  *	internally, the following attributes must be provided: %NL80211_ATTR_IE,
343  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IE_PROBE_RESP and %NL80211_ATTR_IE_ASSOC_RESP.
344  * @NL80211_CMD_START_AP: Start AP operation on an AP interface, parameters
345  *	are like for %NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON, and additionally parameters that
346  *	do not change are used, these include %NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_INTERVAL,
347  *	%NL80211_ATTR_DTIM_PERIOD, %NL80211_ATTR_SSID,
348  *	%NL80211_ATTR_HIDDEN_SSID, %NL80211_ATTR_CIPHERS_PAIRWISE,
349  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_GROUP, %NL80211_ATTR_WPA_VERSIONS,
350  *	%NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES, %NL80211_ATTR_PRIVACY,
351  *	%NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE, %NL80211_ATTR_INACTIVITY_TIMEOUT,
352  *	%NL80211_ATTR_ACL_POLICY and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ADDRS.
353  *	The channel to use can be set on the interface or be given using the
354  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ and the attributes determining channel width.
355  * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_BEACON: old alias for %NL80211_CMD_START_AP
356  * @NL80211_CMD_STOP_AP: Stop AP operation on the given interface
357  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_BEACON: old alias for %NL80211_CMD_STOP_AP
358  *
359  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_STATION: Get station attributes for station identified by
360  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC on the interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
361  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION: Set station attributes for station identified by
362  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC on the interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
363  * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION: Add a station with given attributes to the
364  *	the interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
365  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_STATION: Remove a station identified by %NL80211_ATTR_MAC
366  *	or, if no MAC address given, all stations, on the interface identified
367  *	by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX. %NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE and
368  *	%NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE can optionally be used to specify which type
369  *	of disconnection indication should be sent to the station
370  *	(Deauthentication or Disassociation frame and reason code for that
371  *	frame).
372  *
373  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_MPATH: Get mesh path attributes for mesh path to
374  * 	destination %NL80211_ATTR_MAC on the interface identified by
375  * 	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
376  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MPATH:  Set mesh path attributes for mesh path to
377  * 	destination %NL80211_ATTR_MAC on the interface identified by
378  * 	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
379  * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_MPATH: Create a new mesh path for the destination given by
380  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC via %NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_NEXT_HOP.
381  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_MPATH: Delete a mesh path to the destination given by
382  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC.
383  * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_PATH: Add a mesh path with given attributes to the
384  *	the interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
385  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_PATH: Remove a mesh path identified by %NL80211_ATTR_MAC
386  *	or, if no MAC address given, all mesh paths, on the interface identified
387  *	by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
388  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_BSS: Set BSS attributes for BSS identified by
389  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
390  *
391  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_REG: ask the wireless core to send us its currently set
392  *	regulatory domain. If %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY is specified and the device
393  *	has a private regulatory domain, it will be returned. Otherwise, the
394  *	global regdomain will be returned.
395  *	A device will have a private regulatory domain if it uses the
396  *	regulatory_hint() API. Even when a private regdomain is used the channel
397  *	information will still be mended according to further hints from
398  *	the regulatory core to help with compliance. A dump version of this API
399  *	is now available which will returns the global regdomain as well as
400  *	all private regdomains of present wiphys (for those that have it).
401  *	If a wiphy is self-managed (%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_SELF_MANAGED_REG), then
402  *	its private regdomain is the only valid one for it. The regulatory
403  *	core is not used to help with compliance in this case.
404  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_REG: Set current regulatory domain. CRDA sends this command
405  *	after being queried by the kernel. CRDA replies by sending a regulatory
406  *	domain structure which consists of %NL80211_ATTR_REG_ALPHA set to our
407  *	current alpha2 if it found a match. It also provides
408  * 	NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_FLAGS, and a set of regulatory rules. Each
409  * 	regulatory rule is a nested set of attributes  given by
410  * 	%NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_FREQ_[START|END] and
411  * 	%NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_MAX_BW with an attached power rule given by
412  * 	%NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_POWER_MAX_ANT_GAIN and
413  * 	%NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_POWER_MAX_EIRP.
414  * @NL80211_CMD_REQ_SET_REG: ask the wireless core to set the regulatory domain
415  * 	to the specified ISO/IEC 3166-1 alpha2 country code. The core will
416  * 	store this as a valid request and then query userspace for it.
417  *
418  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_MESH_CONFIG: Get mesh networking properties for the
419  *	interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX
420  *
421  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MESH_CONFIG: Set mesh networking properties for the
422  *      interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX
423  *
424  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE: Set extra IEs for management frames. The
425  *	interface is identified with %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX and the management
426  *	frame subtype with %NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE. The extra IE data to be
427  *	added to the end of the specified management frame is specified with
428  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IE. If the command succeeds, the requested data will be
429  *	added to all specified management frames generated by
430  *	kernel/firmware/driver.
431  *	Note: This command has been removed and it is only reserved at this
432  *	point to avoid re-using existing command number. The functionality this
433  *	command was planned for has been provided with cleaner design with the
434  *	option to specify additional IEs in NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN,
435  *	NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE, NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE,
436  *	NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE, and NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE.
437  *
438  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_SCAN: get scan results
439  * @NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN: trigger a new scan with the given parameters
440  *	%NL80211_ATTR_TX_NO_CCK_RATE is used to decide whether to send the
441  *	probe requests at CCK rate or not. %NL80211_ATTR_BSSID can be used to
442  *	specify a BSSID to scan for; if not included, the wildcard BSSID will
443  *	be used.
444  * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_SCAN_RESULTS: scan notification (as a reply to
445  *	NL80211_CMD_GET_SCAN and on the "scan" multicast group)
446  * @NL80211_CMD_SCAN_ABORTED: scan was aborted, for unspecified reasons,
447  *	partial scan results may be available
448  *
449  * @NL80211_CMD_START_SCHED_SCAN: start a scheduled scan at certain
450  *	intervals and certain number of cycles, as specified by
451  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS. If %NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS is
452  *	not specified and only %NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_INTERVAL is specified,
453  *	scheduled scan will run in an infinite loop with the specified interval.
454  *	These attributes are mutually exculsive,
455  *	i.e. NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_INTERVAL must not be passed if
456  *	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS is defined.
457  *	If for some reason scheduled scan is aborted by the driver, all scan
458  *	plans are canceled (including scan plans that did not start yet).
459  *	Like with normal scans, if SSIDs (%NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SSIDS)
460  *	are passed, they are used in the probe requests.  For
461  *	broadcast, a broadcast SSID must be passed (ie. an empty
462  *	string).  If no SSID is passed, no probe requests are sent and
463  *	a passive scan is performed.  %NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES,
464  *	if passed, define which channels should be scanned; if not
465  *	passed, all channels allowed for the current regulatory domain
466  *	are used.  Extra IEs can also be passed from the userspace by
467  *	using the %NL80211_ATTR_IE attribute.  The first cycle of the
468  *	scheduled scan can be delayed by %NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_DELAY
469  *	is supplied. If the device supports multiple concurrent scheduled
470  *	scans, it will allow such when the caller provides the flag attribute
471  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MULTI to indicate user-space support for it.
472  * @NL80211_CMD_STOP_SCHED_SCAN: stop a scheduled scan. Returns -ENOENT if
473  *	scheduled scan is not running. The caller may assume that as soon
474  *	as the call returns, it is safe to start a new scheduled scan again.
475  * @NL80211_CMD_SCHED_SCAN_RESULTS: indicates that there are scheduled scan
476  *	results available.
477  * @NL80211_CMD_SCHED_SCAN_STOPPED: indicates that the scheduled scan has
478  *	stopped.  The driver may issue this event at any time during a
479  *	scheduled scan.  One reason for stopping the scan is if the hardware
480  *	does not support starting an association or a normal scan while running
481  *	a scheduled scan.  This event is also sent when the
482  *	%NL80211_CMD_STOP_SCHED_SCAN command is received or when the interface
483  *	is brought down while a scheduled scan was running.
484  *
485  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_SURVEY: get survey resuls, e.g. channel occupation
486  *      or noise level
487  * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_SURVEY_RESULTS: survey data notification (as a reply to
488  *	NL80211_CMD_GET_SURVEY and on the "scan" multicast group)
489  *
490  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA: Add a PMKSA cache entry using %NL80211_ATTR_MAC
491  *	(for the BSSID), %NL80211_ATTR_PMKID, and optionally %NL80211_ATTR_PMK
492  *	(PMK is used for PTKSA derivation in case of FILS shared key offload) or
493  *	using %NL80211_ATTR_SSID, %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID,
494  *	%NL80211_ATTR_PMKID, and %NL80211_ATTR_PMK in case of FILS
495  *	authentication where %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID is the identifier
496  *	advertized by a FILS capable AP identifying the scope of PMKSA in an
497  *	ESS.
498  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMKSA: Delete a PMKSA cache entry, using %NL80211_ATTR_MAC
499  *	(for the BSSID) and %NL80211_ATTR_PMKID or using %NL80211_ATTR_SSID,
500  *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID, and %NL80211_ATTR_PMKID in case of FILS
501  *	authentication.
502  * @NL80211_CMD_FLUSH_PMKSA: Flush all PMKSA cache entries.
503  *
504  * @NL80211_CMD_REG_CHANGE: indicates to userspace the regulatory domain
505  * 	has been changed and provides details of the request information
506  * 	that caused the change such as who initiated the regulatory request
507  * 	(%NL80211_ATTR_REG_INITIATOR), the wiphy_idx
508  * 	(%NL80211_ATTR_REG_ALPHA2) on which the request was made from if
509  * 	the initiator was %NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_COUNTRY_IE or
510  * 	%NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_DRIVER, the type of regulatory domain
511  * 	set (%NL80211_ATTR_REG_TYPE), if the type of regulatory domain is
512  * 	%NL80211_REG_TYPE_COUNTRY the alpha2 to which we have moved on
513  * 	to (%NL80211_ATTR_REG_ALPHA2).
514  * @NL80211_CMD_REG_BEACON_HINT: indicates to userspace that an AP beacon
515  * 	has been found while world roaming thus enabling active scan or
516  * 	any mode of operation that initiates TX (beacons) on a channel
517  * 	where we would not have been able to do either before. As an example
518  * 	if you are world roaming (regulatory domain set to world or if your
519  * 	driver is using a custom world roaming regulatory domain) and while
520  * 	doing a passive scan on the 5 GHz band you find an AP there (if not
521  * 	on a DFS channel) you will now be able to actively scan for that AP
522  * 	or use AP mode on your card on that same channel. Note that this will
523  * 	never be used for channels 1-11 on the 2 GHz band as they are always
524  * 	enabled world wide. This beacon hint is only sent if your device had
525  * 	either disabled active scanning or beaconing on a channel. We send to
526  * 	userspace the wiphy on which we removed a restriction from
527  * 	(%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY) and the channel on which this occurred
528  * 	before (%NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_BEFORE) and after (%NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_AFTER)
529  * 	the beacon hint was processed.
530  *
531  * @NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE: authentication request and notification.
532  *	This command is used both as a command (request to authenticate) and
533  *	as an event on the "mlme" multicast group indicating completion of the
534  *	authentication process.
535  *	When used as a command, %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is used to identify the
536  *	interface. %NL80211_ATTR_MAC is used to specify PeerSTAAddress (and
537  *	BSSID in case of station mode). %NL80211_ATTR_SSID is used to specify
538  *	the SSID (mainly for association, but is included in authentication
539  *	request, too, to help BSS selection. %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ is used
540  *	to specify the frequence of the channel in MHz. %NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE
541  *	is used to specify the authentication type. %NL80211_ATTR_IE is used to
542  *	define IEs (VendorSpecificInfo, but also including RSN IE and FT IEs)
543  *	to be added to the frame.
544  *	When used as an event, this reports reception of an Authentication
545  *	frame in station and IBSS modes when the local MLME processed the
546  *	frame, i.e., it was for the local STA and was received in correct
547  *	state. This is similar to MLME-AUTHENTICATE.confirm primitive in the
548  *	MLME SAP interface (kernel providing MLME, userspace SME). The
549  *	included %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME attribute contains the management frame
550  *	(including both the header and frame body, but not FCS). This event is
551  *	also used to indicate if the authentication attempt timed out. In that
552  *	case the %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME attribute is replaced with a
553  *	%NL80211_ATTR_TIMED_OUT flag (and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC to indicate which
554  *	pending authentication timed out).
555  * @NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE: association request and notification; like
556  *	NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE but for Association and Reassociation
557  *	(similar to MLME-ASSOCIATE.request, MLME-REASSOCIATE.request,
558  *	MLME-ASSOCIATE.confirm or MLME-REASSOCIATE.confirm primitives). The
559  *	%NL80211_ATTR_PREV_BSSID attribute is used to specify whether the
560  *	request is for the initial association to an ESS (that attribute not
561  *	included) or for reassociation within the ESS (that attribute is
562  *	included).
563  * @NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE: deauthentication request and notification; like
564  *	NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE but for Deauthentication frames (similar to
565  *	MLME-DEAUTHENTICATION.request and MLME-DEAUTHENTICATE.indication
566  *	primitives).
567  * @NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE: disassociation request and notification; like
568  *	NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE but for Disassociation frames (similar to
569  *	MLME-DISASSOCIATE.request and MLME-DISASSOCIATE.indication primitives).
570  *
571  * @NL80211_CMD_MICHAEL_MIC_FAILURE: notification of a locally detected Michael
572  *	MIC (part of TKIP) failure; sent on the "mlme" multicast group; the
573  *	event includes %NL80211_ATTR_MAC to describe the source MAC address of
574  *	the frame with invalid MIC, %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_TYPE to show the key
575  *	type, %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX to indicate the key identifier, and
576  *	%NL80211_ATTR_KEY_SEQ to indicate the TSC value of the frame; this
577  *	event matches with MLME-MICHAELMICFAILURE.indication() primitive
578  *
579  * @NL80211_CMD_JOIN_IBSS: Join a new IBSS -- given at least an SSID and a
580  *	FREQ attribute (for the initial frequency if no peer can be found)
581  *	and optionally a MAC (as BSSID) and FREQ_FIXED attribute if those
582  *	should be fixed rather than automatically determined. Can only be
583  *	executed on a network interface that is UP, and fixed BSSID/FREQ
584  *	may be rejected. Another optional parameter is the beacon interval,
585  *	given in the %NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_INTERVAL attribute, which if not
586  *	given defaults to 100 TU (102.4ms).
587  * @NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_IBSS: Leave the IBSS -- no special arguments, the IBSS is
588  *	determined by the network interface.
589  *
590  * @NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE: testmode command, takes a wiphy (or ifindex) attribute
591  *	to identify the device, and the TESTDATA blob attribute to pass through
592  *	to the driver.
593  *
594  * @NL80211_CMD_CONNECT: connection request and notification; this command
595  *	requests to connect to a specified network but without separating
596  *	auth and assoc steps. For this, you need to specify the SSID in a
597  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SSID attribute, and can optionally specify the association
598  *	IEs in %NL80211_ATTR_IE, %NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE, %NL80211_ATTR_USE_MFP,
599  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC, %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ, %NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT,
600  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE,
601  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_ENCRYPT,
602  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211, %NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT, and
603  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_HINT.
604  *	If included, %NL80211_ATTR_MAC and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ are
605  *	restrictions on BSS selection, i.e., they effectively prevent roaming
606  *	within the ESS. %NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_HINT
607  *	can be included to provide a recommendation of the initial BSS while
608  *	allowing the driver to roam to other BSSes within the ESS and also to
609  *	ignore this recommendation if the indicated BSS is not ideal. Only one
610  *	set of BSSID,frequency parameters is used (i.e., either the enforcing
611  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC,%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ or the less strict
612  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_HINT).
613  *	Driver shall not modify the IEs specified through %NL80211_ATTR_IE if
614  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC is included. However, if %NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT is
615  *	included, these IEs through %NL80211_ATTR_IE are specified by the user
616  *	space based on the best possible BSS selected. Thus, if the driver ends
617  *	up selecting a different BSS, it can modify these IEs accordingly (e.g.
618  *	userspace asks the driver to perform PMKSA caching with BSS1 and the
619  *	driver ends up selecting BSS2 with different PMKSA cache entry; RSNIE
620  *	has to get updated with the apt PMKID).
621  *	%NL80211_ATTR_PREV_BSSID can be used to request a reassociation within
622  *	the ESS in case the device is already associated and an association with
623  *	a different BSS is desired.
624  *	Background scan period can optionally be
625  *	specified in %NL80211_ATTR_BG_SCAN_PERIOD,
626  *	if not specified default background scan configuration
627  *	in driver is used and if period value is 0, bg scan will be disabled.
628  *	This attribute is ignored if driver does not support roam scan.
629  *	It is also sent as an event, with the BSSID and response IEs when the
630  *	connection is established or failed to be established. This can be
631  *	determined by the %NL80211_ATTR_STATUS_CODE attribute (0 = success,
632  *	non-zero = failure). If %NL80211_ATTR_TIMED_OUT is included in the
633  *	event, the connection attempt failed due to not being able to initiate
634  *	authentication/association or not receiving a response from the AP.
635  *	Non-zero %NL80211_ATTR_STATUS_CODE value is indicated in that case as
636  *	well to remain backwards compatible.
637  *	When establishing a security association, drivers that support 4 way
638  *	handshake offload should send %NL80211_CMD_PORT_AUTHORIZED event when
639  *	the 4 way handshake is completed successfully.
640  * @NL80211_CMD_ROAM: Notification indicating the card/driver roamed by itself.
641  *	When a security association was established with the new AP (e.g. if
642  *	the FT protocol was used for roaming or the driver completed the 4 way
643  *	handshake), this event should be followed by an
644  *	%NL80211_CMD_PORT_AUTHORIZED event.
645  * @NL80211_CMD_DISCONNECT: drop a given connection; also used to notify
646  *	userspace that a connection was dropped by the AP or due to other
647  *	reasons, for this the %NL80211_ATTR_DISCONNECTED_BY_AP and
648  *	%NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE attributes are used.
649  *
650  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_WIPHY_NETNS: Set a wiphy's netns. Note that all devices
651  *	associated with this wiphy must be down and will follow.
652  *
653  * @NL80211_CMD_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL: Request to remain awake on the specified
654  *	channel for the specified amount of time. This can be used to do
655  *	off-channel operations like transmit a Public Action frame and wait for
656  *	a response while being associated to an AP on another channel.
657  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is used to specify which interface (and thus
658  *	radio) is used. %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ is used to specify the
659  *	frequency for the operation.
660  *	%NL80211_ATTR_DURATION is used to specify the duration in milliseconds
661  *	to remain on the channel. This command is also used as an event to
662  *	notify when the requested duration starts (it may take a while for the
663  *	driver to schedule this time due to other concurrent needs for the
664  *	radio).
665  *	When called, this operation returns a cookie (%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE)
666  *	that will be included with any events pertaining to this request;
667  *	the cookie is also used to cancel the request.
668  * @NL80211_CMD_CANCEL_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL: This command can be used to cancel a
669  *	pending remain-on-channel duration if the desired operation has been
670  *	completed prior to expiration of the originally requested duration.
671  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY or %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is used to specify the
672  *	radio. The %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE attribute must be given as well to
673  *	uniquely identify the request.
674  *	This command is also used as an event to notify when a requested
675  *	remain-on-channel duration has expired.
676  *
677  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_TX_BITRATE_MASK: Set the mask of rates to be used in TX
678  *	rate selection. %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is used to specify the interface
679  *	and @NL80211_ATTR_TX_RATES the set of allowed rates.
680  *
681  * @NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME: Register for receiving certain mgmt frames
682  *	(via @NL80211_CMD_FRAME) for processing in userspace. This command
683  *	requires an interface index, a frame type attribute (optional for
684  *	backward compatibility reasons, if not given assumes action frames)
685  *	and a match attribute containing the first few bytes of the frame
686  *	that should match, e.g. a single byte for only a category match or
687  *	four bytes for vendor frames including the OUI. The registration
688  *	cannot be dropped, but is removed automatically when the netlink
689  *	socket is closed. Multiple registrations can be made.
690  * @NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_ACTION: Alias for @NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME for
691  *	backward compatibility
692  * @NL80211_CMD_FRAME: Management frame TX request and RX notification. This
693  *	command is used both as a request to transmit a management frame and
694  *	as an event indicating reception of a frame that was not processed in
695  *	kernel code, but is for us (i.e., which may need to be processed in a
696  *	user space application). %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME is used to specify the
697  *	frame contents (including header). %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ is used
698  *	to indicate on which channel the frame is to be transmitted or was
699  *	received. If this channel is not the current channel (remain-on-channel
700  *	or the operational channel) the device will switch to the given channel
701  *	and transmit the frame, optionally waiting for a response for the time
702  *	specified using %NL80211_ATTR_DURATION. When called, this operation
703  *	returns a cookie (%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE) that will be included with the
704  *	TX status event pertaining to the TX request.
705  *	%NL80211_ATTR_TX_NO_CCK_RATE is used to decide whether to send the
706  *	management frames at CCK rate or not in 2GHz band.
707  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFFSETS_TX is an array of offsets to CSA
708  *	counters which will be updated to the current value. This attribute
709  *	is used during CSA period.
710  * @NL80211_CMD_FRAME_WAIT_CANCEL: When an off-channel TX was requested, this
711  *	command may be used with the corresponding cookie to cancel the wait
712  *	time if it is known that it is no longer necessary.  This command is
713  *	also sent as an event whenever the driver has completed the off-channel
714  *	wait time.
715  * @NL80211_CMD_ACTION: Alias for @NL80211_CMD_FRAME for backward compatibility.
716  * @NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS: Report TX status of a management frame
717  *	transmitted with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME. %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE identifies
718  *	the TX command and %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME includes the contents of the
719  *	frame. %NL80211_ATTR_ACK flag is included if the recipient acknowledged
720  *	the frame.
721  * @NL80211_CMD_ACTION_TX_STATUS: Alias for @NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS for
722  *	backward compatibility.
723  *
724  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_POWER_SAVE: Set powersave, using %NL80211_ATTR_PS_STATE
725  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_POWER_SAVE: Get powersave status in %NL80211_ATTR_PS_STATE
726  *
727  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_CQM: Connection quality monitor configuration. This command
728  *	is used to configure connection quality monitoring notification trigger
729  *	levels.
730  * @NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_CQM: Connection quality monitor notification. This
731  *	command is used as an event to indicate the that a trigger level was
732  *	reached.
733  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_CHANNEL: Set the channel (using %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ
734  *	and the attributes determining channel width) the given interface
735  *	(identifed by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX) shall operate on.
736  *	In case multiple channels are supported by the device, the mechanism
737  *	with which it switches channels is implementation-defined.
738  *	When a monitor interface is given, it can only switch channel while
739  *	no other interfaces are operating to avoid disturbing the operation
740  *	of any other interfaces, and other interfaces will again take
741  *	precedence when they are used.
742  *
743  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_WDS_PEER: Set the MAC address of the peer on a WDS interface.
744  *
745  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MULTICAST_TO_UNICAST: Configure if this AP should perform
746  *	multicast to unicast conversion. When enabled, all multicast packets
747  *	with ethertype ARP, IPv4 or IPv6 (possibly within an 802.1Q header)
748  *	will be sent out to each station once with the destination (multicast)
749  *	MAC address replaced by the station's MAC address. Note that this may
750  *	break certain expectations of the receiver, e.g. the ability to drop
751  *	unicast IP packets encapsulated in multicast L2 frames, or the ability
752  *	to not send destination unreachable messages in such cases.
753  *	This can only be toggled per BSS. Configure this on an interface of
754  *	type %NL80211_IFTYPE_AP. It applies to all its VLAN interfaces
755  *	(%NL80211_IFTYPE_AP_VLAN), except for those in 4addr (WDS) mode.
756  *	If %NL80211_ATTR_MULTICAST_TO_UNICAST_ENABLED is not present with this
757  *	command, the feature is disabled.
758  *
759  * @NL80211_CMD_JOIN_MESH: Join a mesh. The mesh ID must be given, and initial
760  *	mesh config parameters may be given.
761  * @NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_MESH: Leave the mesh network -- no special arguments, the
762  *	network is determined by the network interface.
763  *
764  * @NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_DEAUTHENTICATE: Unprotected deauthentication frame
765  *	notification. This event is used to indicate that an unprotected
766  *	deauthentication frame was dropped when MFP is in use.
767  * @NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_DISASSOCIATE: Unprotected disassociation frame
768  *	notification. This event is used to indicate that an unprotected
769  *	disassociation frame was dropped when MFP is in use.
770  *
771  * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_PEER_CANDIDATE: Notification on the reception of a
772  *      beacon or probe response from a compatible mesh peer.  This is only
773  *      sent while no station information (sta_info) exists for the new peer
774  *      candidate and when @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH,
775  *      @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AMPE, or
776  *      @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_MPM is set.  On reception of this
777  *      notification, userspace may decide to create a new station
778  *      (@NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION).  To stop this notification from
779  *      reoccurring, the userspace authentication daemon may want to create the
780  *      new station with the AUTHENTICATED flag unset and maybe change it later
781  *      depending on the authentication result.
782  *
783  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_WOWLAN: get Wake-on-Wireless-LAN (WoWLAN) settings.
784  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_WOWLAN: set Wake-on-Wireless-LAN (WoWLAN) settings.
785  *	Since wireless is more complex than wired ethernet, it supports
786  *	various triggers. These triggers can be configured through this
787  *	command with the %NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS attribute. For
788  *	more background information, see
789  *	http://wireless.kernel.org/en/users/Documentation/WoWLAN.
790  *	The @NL80211_CMD_SET_WOWLAN command can also be used as a notification
791  *	from the driver reporting the wakeup reason. In this case, the
792  *	@NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS attribute will contain the reason
793  *	for the wakeup, if it was caused by wireless. If it is not present
794  *	in the wakeup notification, the wireless device didn't cause the
795  *	wakeup but reports that it was woken up.
796  *
797  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_REKEY_OFFLOAD: This command is used give the driver
798  *	the necessary information for supporting GTK rekey offload. This
799  *	feature is typically used during WoWLAN. The configuration data
800  *	is contained in %NL80211_ATTR_REKEY_DATA (which is nested and
801  *	contains the data in sub-attributes). After rekeying happened,
802  *	this command may also be sent by the driver as an MLME event to
803  *	inform userspace of the new replay counter.
804  *
805  * @NL80211_CMD_PMKSA_CANDIDATE: This is used as an event to inform userspace
806  *	of PMKSA caching dandidates.
807  *
808  * @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_OPER: Perform a high-level TDLS command (e.g. link setup).
809  *	In addition, this can be used as an event to request userspace to take
810  *	actions on TDLS links (set up a new link or tear down an existing one).
811  *	In such events, %NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_OPERATION indicates the requested
812  *	operation, %NL80211_ATTR_MAC contains the peer MAC address, and
813  *	%NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE the reason code to be used (only with
814  *	%NL80211_TDLS_TEARDOWN).
815  * @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_MGMT: Send a TDLS management frame. The
816  *	%NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_ACTION attribute determines the type of frame to be
817  *	sent. Public Action codes (802.11-2012 8.1.5.1) will be sent as
818  *	802.11 management frames, while TDLS action codes (802.11-2012
819  *	8.5.13.1) will be encapsulated and sent as data frames. The currently
820  *	supported Public Action code is %WLAN_PUB_ACTION_TDLS_DISCOVER_RES
821  *	and the currently supported TDLS actions codes are given in
822  *	&enum ieee80211_tdls_actioncode.
823  *
824  * @NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_FRAME: Used by an application controlling an AP
825  *	(or GO) interface (i.e. hostapd) to ask for unexpected frames to
826  *	implement sending deauth to stations that send unexpected class 3
827  *	frames. Also used as the event sent by the kernel when such a frame
828  *	is received.
829  *	For the event, the %NL80211_ATTR_MAC attribute carries the TA and
830  *	other attributes like the interface index are present.
831  *	If used as the command it must have an interface index and you can
832  *	only unsubscribe from the event by closing the socket. Subscription
833  *	is also for %NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_4ADDR_FRAME events.
834  *
835  * @NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_4ADDR_FRAME: Sent as an event indicating that the
836  *	associated station identified by %NL80211_ATTR_MAC sent a 4addr frame
837  *	and wasn't already in a 4-addr VLAN. The event will be sent similarly
838  *	to the %NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_FRAME event, to the same listener.
839  *
840  * @NL80211_CMD_PROBE_CLIENT: Probe an associated station on an AP interface
841  *	by sending a null data frame to it and reporting when the frame is
842  *	acknowleged. This is used to allow timing out inactive clients. Uses
843  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC. The command returns a
844  *	direct reply with an %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE that is later used to match
845  *	up the event with the request. The event includes the same data and
846  *	has %NL80211_ATTR_ACK set if the frame was ACKed.
847  *
848  * @NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_BEACONS: Register this socket to receive beacons from
849  *	other BSSes when any interfaces are in AP mode. This helps implement
850  *	OLBC handling in hostapd. Beacons are reported in %NL80211_CMD_FRAME
851  *	messages. Note that per PHY only one application may register.
852  *
853  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_NOACK_MAP: sets a bitmap for the individual TIDs whether
854  *      No Acknowledgement Policy should be applied.
855  *
856  * @NL80211_CMD_CH_SWITCH_NOTIFY: An AP or GO may decide to switch channels
857  *	independently of the userspace SME, send this event indicating
858  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is now on %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ and the
859  *	attributes determining channel width.  This indication may also be
860  *	sent when a remotely-initiated switch (e.g., when a STA receives a CSA
861  *	from the remote AP) is completed;
862  *
863  * @NL80211_CMD_CH_SWITCH_STARTED_NOTIFY: Notify that a channel switch
864  *	has been started on an interface, regardless of the initiator
865  *	(ie. whether it was requested from a remote device or
866  *	initiated on our own).  It indicates that
867  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX will be on %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ
868  *	after %NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_COUNT TBTT's.  The userspace may
869  *	decide to react to this indication by requesting other
870  *	interfaces to change channel as well.
871  *
872  * @NL80211_CMD_START_P2P_DEVICE: Start the given P2P Device, identified by
873  *	its %NL80211_ATTR_WDEV identifier. It must have been created with
874  *	%NL80211_CMD_NEW_INTERFACE previously. After it has been started, the
875  *	P2P Device can be used for P2P operations, e.g. remain-on-channel and
876  *	public action frame TX.
877  * @NL80211_CMD_STOP_P2P_DEVICE: Stop the given P2P Device, identified by
878  *	its %NL80211_ATTR_WDEV identifier.
879  *
880  * @NL80211_CMD_CONN_FAILED: connection request to an AP failed; used to
881  *	notify userspace that AP has rejected the connection request from a
882  *	station, due to particular reason. %NL80211_ATTR_CONN_FAILED_REASON
883  *	is used for this.
884  *
885  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MCAST_RATE: Change the rate used to send multicast frames
886  *	for IBSS or MESH vif.
887  *
888  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MAC_ACL: sets ACL for MAC address based access control.
889  *	This is to be used with the drivers advertising the support of MAC
890  *	address based access control. List of MAC addresses is passed in
891  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ADDRS and ACL policy is passed in
892  *	%NL80211_ATTR_ACL_POLICY. Driver will enable ACL with this list, if it
893  *	is not already done. The new list will replace any existing list. Driver
894  *	will clear its ACL when the list of MAC addresses passed is empty. This
895  *	command is used in AP/P2P GO mode. Driver has to make sure to clear its
896  *	ACL list during %NL80211_CMD_STOP_AP.
897  *
898  * @NL80211_CMD_RADAR_DETECT: Start a Channel availability check (CAC). Once
899  *	a radar is detected or the channel availability scan (CAC) has finished
900  *	or was aborted, or a radar was detected, usermode will be notified with
901  *	this event. This command is also used to notify userspace about radars
902  *	while operating on this channel.
903  *	%NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_EVENT is used to inform about the type of the
904  *	event.
905  *
906  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_PROTOCOL_FEATURES: Get global nl80211 protocol features,
907  *	i.e. features for the nl80211 protocol rather than device features.
908  *	Returns the features in the %NL80211_ATTR_PROTOCOL_FEATURES bitmap.
909  *
910  * @NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_FT_IES: Pass down the most up-to-date Fast Transition
911  *	Information Element to the WLAN driver
912  *
913  * @NL80211_CMD_FT_EVENT: Send a Fast transition event from the WLAN driver
914  *	to the supplicant. This will carry the target AP's MAC address along
915  *	with the relevant Information Elements. This event is used to report
916  *	received FT IEs (MDIE, FTIE, RSN IE, TIE, RICIE).
917  *
918  * @NL80211_CMD_CRIT_PROTOCOL_START: Indicates user-space will start running
919  *	a critical protocol that needs more reliability in the connection to
920  *	complete.
921  *
922  * @NL80211_CMD_CRIT_PROTOCOL_STOP: Indicates the connection reliability can
923  *	return back to normal.
924  *
925  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_COALESCE: Get currently supported coalesce rules.
926  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_COALESCE: Configure coalesce rules or clear existing rules.
927  *
928  * @NL80211_CMD_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Perform a channel switch by announcing the
929  *	the new channel information (Channel Switch Announcement - CSA)
930  *	in the beacon for some time (as defined in the
931  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_COUNT parameter) and then change to the
932  *	new channel. Userspace provides the new channel information (using
933  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ and the attributes determining channel
934  *	width). %NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_BLOCK_TX may be supplied to inform
935  *	other station that transmission must be blocked until the channel
936  *	switch is complete.
937  *
938  * @NL80211_CMD_VENDOR: Vendor-specified command/event. The command is specified
939  *	by the %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_ID attribute and a sub-command in
940  *	%NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_SUBCMD. Parameter(s) can be transported in
941  *	%NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA.
942  *	For feature advertisement, the %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA attribute is
943  *	used in the wiphy data as a nested attribute containing descriptions
944  *	(&struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info) of the supported vendor commands.
945  *	This may also be sent as an event with the same attributes.
946  *
947  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_QOS_MAP: Set Interworking QoS mapping for IP DSCP values.
948  *	The QoS mapping information is included in %NL80211_ATTR_QOS_MAP. If
949  *	that attribute is not included, QoS mapping is disabled. Since this
950  *	QoS mapping is relevant for IP packets, it is only valid during an
951  *	association. This is cleared on disassociation and AP restart.
952  *
953  * @NL80211_CMD_ADD_TX_TS: Ask the kernel to add a traffic stream for the given
954  *	%NL80211_ATTR_TSID and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC with %NL80211_ATTR_USER_PRIO
955  *	and %NL80211_ATTR_ADMITTED_TIME parameters.
956  *	Note that the action frame handshake with the AP shall be handled by
957  *	userspace via the normal management RX/TX framework, this only sets
958  *	up the TX TS in the driver/device.
959  *	If the admitted time attribute is not added then the request just checks
960  *	if a subsequent setup could be successful, the intent is to use this to
961  *	avoid setting up a session with the AP when local restrictions would
962  *	make that impossible. However, the subsequent "real" setup may still
963  *	fail even if the check was successful.
964  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_TX_TS: Remove an existing TS with the %NL80211_ATTR_TSID
965  *	and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC parameters. It isn't necessary to call this
966  *	before removing a station entry entirely, or before disassociating
967  *	or similar, cleanup will happen in the driver/device in this case.
968  *
969  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_MPP: Get mesh path attributes for mesh proxy path to
970  *	destination %NL80211_ATTR_MAC on the interface identified by
971  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
972  *
973  * @NL80211_CMD_JOIN_OCB: Join the OCB network. The center frequency and
974  *	bandwidth of a channel must be given.
975  * @NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_OCB: Leave the OCB network -- no special arguments, the
976  *	network is determined by the network interface.
977  *
978  * @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Start channel-switching with a TDLS peer,
979  *	identified by the %NL80211_ATTR_MAC parameter. A target channel is
980  *	provided via %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ and other attributes determining
981  *	channel width/type. The target operating class is given via
982  *	%NL80211_ATTR_OPER_CLASS.
983  *	The driver is responsible for continually initiating channel-switching
984  *	operations and returning to the base channel for communication with the
985  *	AP.
986  * @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_CANCEL_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Stop channel-switching with a TDLS
987  *	peer given by %NL80211_ATTR_MAC. Both peers must be on the base channel
988  *	when this command completes.
989  *
990  * @NL80211_CMD_WIPHY_REG_CHANGE: Similar to %NL80211_CMD_REG_CHANGE, but used
991  *	as an event to indicate changes for devices with wiphy-specific regdom
992  *	management.
993  *
994  * @NL80211_CMD_ABORT_SCAN: Stop an ongoing scan. Returns -ENOENT if a scan is
995  *	not running. The driver indicates the status of the scan through
996  *	cfg80211_scan_done().
997  *
998  * @NL80211_CMD_START_NAN: Start NAN operation, identified by its
999  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WDEV interface. This interface must have been
1000  *	previously created with %NL80211_CMD_NEW_INTERFACE. After it
1001  *	has been started, the NAN interface will create or join a
1002  *	cluster. This command must have a valid
1003  *	%NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MASTER_PREF attribute and optional
1004  *	%NL80211_ATTR_BANDS attributes.  If %NL80211_ATTR_BANDS is
1005  *	omitted or set to 0, it means don't-care and the device will
1006  *	decide what to use.  After this command NAN functions can be
1007  *	added.
1008  * @NL80211_CMD_STOP_NAN: Stop the NAN operation, identified by
1009  *	its %NL80211_ATTR_WDEV interface.
1010  * @NL80211_CMD_ADD_NAN_FUNCTION: Add a NAN function. The function is defined
1011  *	with %NL80211_ATTR_NAN_FUNC nested attribute. When called, this
1012  *	operation returns the strictly positive and unique instance id
1013  *	(%NL80211_ATTR_NAN_FUNC_INST_ID) and a cookie (%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE)
1014  *	of the function upon success.
1015  *	Since instance ID's can be re-used, this cookie is the right
1016  *	way to identify the function. This will avoid races when a termination
1017  *	event is handled by the user space after it has already added a new
1018  *	function that got the same instance id from the kernel as the one
1019  *	which just terminated.
1020  *	This cookie may be used in NAN events even before the command
1021  *	returns, so userspace shouldn't process NAN events until it processes
1022  *	the response to this command.
1023  *	Look at %NL80211_ATTR_SOCKET_OWNER as well.
1024  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_NAN_FUNCTION: Delete a NAN function by cookie.
1025  *	This command is also used as a notification sent when a NAN function is
1026  *	terminated. This will contain a %NL80211_ATTR_NAN_FUNC_INST_ID
1027  *	and %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE attributes.
1028  * @NL80211_CMD_CHANGE_NAN_CONFIG: Change current NAN
1029  *	configuration. NAN must be operational (%NL80211_CMD_START_NAN
1030  *	was executed).  It must contain at least one of the following
1031  *	attributes: %NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MASTER_PREF,
1032  *	%NL80211_ATTR_BANDS.  If %NL80211_ATTR_BANDS is omitted, the
1033  *	current configuration is not changed.  If it is present but
1034  *	set to zero, the configuration is changed to don't-care
1035  *	(i.e. the device can decide what to do).
1036  * @NL80211_CMD_NAN_FUNC_MATCH: Notification sent when a match is reported.
1037  *	This will contain a %NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MATCH nested attribute and
1038  *	%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE.
1039  *
1040  * @NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_CONNECT_PARAMS: Update one or more connect parameters
1041  *	for subsequent roaming cases if the driver or firmware uses internal
1042  *	BSS selection. This command can be issued only while connected and it
1043  *	does not result in a change for the current association. Currently,
1044  *	only the %NL80211_ATTR_IE data is used and updated with this command.
1045  *
1046  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_PMK: For offloaded 4-Way handshake, set the PMK or PMK-R0
1047  *	for the given authenticator address (specified with %NL80211_ATTR_MAC).
1048  *	When %NL80211_ATTR_PMKR0_NAME is set, %NL80211_ATTR_PMK specifies the
1049  *	PMK-R0, otherwise it specifies the PMK.
1050  * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMK: For offloaded 4-Way handshake, delete the previously
1051  *	configured PMK for the authenticator address identified by
1052  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC.
1053  * @NL80211_CMD_PORT_AUTHORIZED: An event that indicates that the 4 way
1054  *	handshake was completed successfully by the driver. The BSSID is
1055  *	specified with %NL80211_ATTR_MAC. Drivers that support 4 way handshake
1056  *	offload should send this event after indicating 802.11 association with
1057  *	%NL80211_CMD_CONNECT or %NL80211_CMD_ROAM. If the 4 way handshake failed
1058  *	%NL80211_CMD_DISCONNECT should be indicated instead.
1059  *
1060  * @NL80211_CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME: Control Port (e.g. PAE) frame TX request
1061  *	and RX notification.  This command is used both as a request to transmit
1062  *	a control port frame and as a notification that a control port frame
1063  *	has been received. %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME is used to specify the
1064  *	frame contents.  The frame is the raw EAPoL data, without ethernet or
1065  *	802.11 headers.
1066  *	When used as an event indication %NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE,
1067  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_ENCRYPT and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC are added
1068  *	indicating the protocol type of the received frame; whether the frame
1069  *	was received unencrypted and the MAC address of the peer respectively.
1070  *
1071  * @NL80211_CMD_RELOAD_REGDB: Request that the regdb firmware file is reloaded.
1072  *
1073  * @NL80211_CMD_EXTERNAL_AUTH: This interface is exclusively defined for host
1074  *	drivers that do not define separate commands for authentication and
1075  *	association, but rely on user space for the authentication to happen.
1076  *	This interface acts both as the event request (driver to user space)
1077  *	to trigger the authentication and command response (userspace to
1078  *	driver) to indicate the authentication status.
1079  *
1080  *	User space uses the %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT command to the host driver to
1081  *	trigger a connection. The host driver selects a BSS and further uses
1082  *	this interface to offload only the authentication part to the user
1083  *	space. Authentication frames are passed between the driver and user
1084  *	space through the %NL80211_CMD_FRAME interface. Host driver proceeds
1085  *	further with the association after getting successful authentication
1086  *	status. User space indicates the authentication status through
1087  *	%NL80211_ATTR_STATUS_CODE attribute in %NL80211_CMD_EXTERNAL_AUTH
1088  *	command interface.
1089  *
1090  *	Host driver reports this status on an authentication failure to the
1091  *	user space through the connect result as the user space would have
1092  *	initiated the connection through the connect request.
1093  *
1094  * @NL80211_CMD_STA_OPMODE_CHANGED: An event that notify station's
1095  *	ht opmode or vht opmode changes using any of %NL80211_ATTR_SMPS_MODE,
1096  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CHANNEL_WIDTH,%NL80211_ATTR_NSS attributes with its
1097  *	address(specified in %NL80211_ATTR_MAC).
1098  *
1099  * @NL80211_CMD_GET_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS: Retrieve FTM responder statistics, in
1100  *	the %NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS attribute.
1101  *
1102  * @NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_START: start a (set of) peer measurement(s)
1103  *	with the given parameters, which are encapsulated in the nested
1104  *	%NL80211_ATTR_PEER_MEASUREMENTS attribute. Optionally, MAC address
1105  *	randomization may be enabled and configured by specifying the
1106  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC_MASK attributes.
1107  *	If a timeout is requested, use the %NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT attribute.
1108  *	A u64 cookie for further %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE use is is returned in
1109  *	the netlink extended ack message.
1110  *
1111  *	To cancel a measurement, close the socket that requested it.
1112  *
1113  *	Measurement results are reported to the socket that requested the
1114  *	measurement using @NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_RESULT when they
1115  *	become available, so applications must ensure a large enough socket
1116  *	buffer size.
1117  *
1118  *	Depending on driver support it may or may not be possible to start
1119  *	multiple concurrent measurements.
1120  * @NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_RESULT: This command number is used for the
1121  *	result notification from the driver to the requesting socket.
1122  * @NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_COMPLETE: Notification only, indicating that
1123  *	the measurement completed, using the measurement cookie
1124  *	(%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE).
1125  *
1126  * @NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_RADAR: Notify the kernel that a radar signal was
1127  *	detected and reported by a neighboring device on the channel
1128  *	indicated by %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ and other attributes
1129  *	determining the width and type.
1130  *
1131  * @NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_OWE_INFO: This interface allows the host driver to
1132  *	offload OWE processing to user space. This intends to support
1133  *	OWE AKM by the host drivers that implement SME but rely
1134  *	on the user space for the cryptographic/DH IE processing in AP mode.
1135  *
1136  * @NL80211_CMD_PROBE_MESH_LINK: The requirement for mesh link metric
1137  *	refreshing, is that from one mesh point we be able to send some data
1138  *	frames to other mesh points which are not currently selected as a
1139  *	primary traffic path, but which are only 1 hop away. The absence of
1140  *	the primary path to the chosen node makes it necessary to apply some
1141  *	form of marking on a chosen packet stream so that the packets can be
1142  *	properly steered to the selected node for testing, and not by the
1143  *	regular mesh path lookup. Further, the packets must be of type data
1144  *	so that the rate control (often embedded in firmware) is used for
1145  *	rate selection.
1146  *
1147  *	Here attribute %NL80211_ATTR_MAC is used to specify connected mesh
1148  *	peer MAC address and %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME is used to specify the frame
1149  *	content. The frame is ethernet data.
1150  *
1151  * @NL80211_CMD_SET_TID_CONFIG: Data frame TID specific configuration
1152  *	is passed using %NL80211_ATTR_TID_CONFIG attribute.
1153  *
1154  * @NL80211_CMD_MAX: highest used command number
1155  * @__NL80211_CMD_AFTER_LAST: internal use
1156  */
1157 enum nl80211_commands {
1158 /* don't change the order or add anything between, this is ABI! */
1159 	NL80211_CMD_UNSPEC,
1160 
1161 	NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY,		/* can dump */
1162 	NL80211_CMD_SET_WIPHY,
1163 	NL80211_CMD_NEW_WIPHY,
1164 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_WIPHY,
1165 
1166 	NL80211_CMD_GET_INTERFACE,	/* can dump */
1167 	NL80211_CMD_SET_INTERFACE,
1168 	NL80211_CMD_NEW_INTERFACE,
1169 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_INTERFACE,
1170 
1171 	NL80211_CMD_GET_KEY,
1172 	NL80211_CMD_SET_KEY,
1173 	NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY,
1174 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_KEY,
1175 
1176 	NL80211_CMD_GET_BEACON,
1177 	NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON,
1178 	NL80211_CMD_START_AP,
1179 	NL80211_CMD_NEW_BEACON = NL80211_CMD_START_AP,
1180 	NL80211_CMD_STOP_AP,
1181 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_BEACON = NL80211_CMD_STOP_AP,
1182 
1183 	NL80211_CMD_GET_STATION,
1184 	NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION,
1185 	NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION,
1186 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_STATION,
1187 
1188 	NL80211_CMD_GET_MPATH,
1189 	NL80211_CMD_SET_MPATH,
1190 	NL80211_CMD_NEW_MPATH,
1191 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_MPATH,
1192 
1193 	NL80211_CMD_SET_BSS,
1194 
1195 	NL80211_CMD_SET_REG,
1196 	NL80211_CMD_REQ_SET_REG,
1197 
1198 	NL80211_CMD_GET_MESH_CONFIG,
1199 	NL80211_CMD_SET_MESH_CONFIG,
1200 
1201 	NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE /* reserved; not used */,
1202 
1203 	NL80211_CMD_GET_REG,
1204 
1205 	NL80211_CMD_GET_SCAN,
1206 	NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN,
1207 	NL80211_CMD_NEW_SCAN_RESULTS,
1208 	NL80211_CMD_SCAN_ABORTED,
1209 
1210 	NL80211_CMD_REG_CHANGE,
1211 
1212 	NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE,
1213 	NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE,
1214 	NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE,
1215 	NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE,
1216 
1217 	NL80211_CMD_MICHAEL_MIC_FAILURE,
1218 
1219 	NL80211_CMD_REG_BEACON_HINT,
1220 
1221 	NL80211_CMD_JOIN_IBSS,
1222 	NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_IBSS,
1223 
1224 	NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE,
1225 
1226 	NL80211_CMD_CONNECT,
1227 	NL80211_CMD_ROAM,
1228 	NL80211_CMD_DISCONNECT,
1229 
1230 	NL80211_CMD_SET_WIPHY_NETNS,
1231 
1232 	NL80211_CMD_GET_SURVEY,
1233 	NL80211_CMD_NEW_SURVEY_RESULTS,
1234 
1235 	NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA,
1236 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMKSA,
1237 	NL80211_CMD_FLUSH_PMKSA,
1238 
1239 	NL80211_CMD_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL,
1240 	NL80211_CMD_CANCEL_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL,
1241 
1242 	NL80211_CMD_SET_TX_BITRATE_MASK,
1243 
1244 	NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME,
1245 	NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_ACTION = NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME,
1246 	NL80211_CMD_FRAME,
1247 	NL80211_CMD_ACTION = NL80211_CMD_FRAME,
1248 	NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS,
1249 	NL80211_CMD_ACTION_TX_STATUS = NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS,
1250 
1251 	NL80211_CMD_SET_POWER_SAVE,
1252 	NL80211_CMD_GET_POWER_SAVE,
1253 
1254 	NL80211_CMD_SET_CQM,
1255 	NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_CQM,
1256 
1257 	NL80211_CMD_SET_CHANNEL,
1258 	NL80211_CMD_SET_WDS_PEER,
1259 
1260 	NL80211_CMD_FRAME_WAIT_CANCEL,
1261 
1262 	NL80211_CMD_JOIN_MESH,
1263 	NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_MESH,
1264 
1265 	NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_DEAUTHENTICATE,
1266 	NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_DISASSOCIATE,
1267 
1268 	NL80211_CMD_NEW_PEER_CANDIDATE,
1269 
1270 	NL80211_CMD_GET_WOWLAN,
1271 	NL80211_CMD_SET_WOWLAN,
1272 
1273 	NL80211_CMD_START_SCHED_SCAN,
1274 	NL80211_CMD_STOP_SCHED_SCAN,
1275 	NL80211_CMD_SCHED_SCAN_RESULTS,
1276 	NL80211_CMD_SCHED_SCAN_STOPPED,
1277 
1278 	NL80211_CMD_SET_REKEY_OFFLOAD,
1279 
1280 	NL80211_CMD_PMKSA_CANDIDATE,
1281 
1282 	NL80211_CMD_TDLS_OPER,
1283 	NL80211_CMD_TDLS_MGMT,
1284 
1285 	NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_FRAME,
1286 
1287 	NL80211_CMD_PROBE_CLIENT,
1288 
1289 	NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_BEACONS,
1290 
1291 	NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_4ADDR_FRAME,
1292 
1293 	NL80211_CMD_SET_NOACK_MAP,
1294 
1295 	NL80211_CMD_CH_SWITCH_NOTIFY,
1296 
1297 	NL80211_CMD_START_P2P_DEVICE,
1298 	NL80211_CMD_STOP_P2P_DEVICE,
1299 
1300 	NL80211_CMD_CONN_FAILED,
1301 
1302 	NL80211_CMD_SET_MCAST_RATE,
1303 
1304 	NL80211_CMD_SET_MAC_ACL,
1305 
1306 	NL80211_CMD_RADAR_DETECT,
1307 
1308 	NL80211_CMD_GET_PROTOCOL_FEATURES,
1309 
1310 	NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_FT_IES,
1311 	NL80211_CMD_FT_EVENT,
1312 
1313 	NL80211_CMD_CRIT_PROTOCOL_START,
1314 	NL80211_CMD_CRIT_PROTOCOL_STOP,
1315 
1316 	NL80211_CMD_GET_COALESCE,
1317 	NL80211_CMD_SET_COALESCE,
1318 
1319 	NL80211_CMD_CHANNEL_SWITCH,
1320 
1321 	NL80211_CMD_VENDOR,
1322 
1323 	NL80211_CMD_SET_QOS_MAP,
1324 
1325 	NL80211_CMD_ADD_TX_TS,
1326 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_TX_TS,
1327 
1328 	NL80211_CMD_GET_MPP,
1329 
1330 	NL80211_CMD_JOIN_OCB,
1331 	NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_OCB,
1332 
1333 	NL80211_CMD_CH_SWITCH_STARTED_NOTIFY,
1334 
1335 	NL80211_CMD_TDLS_CHANNEL_SWITCH,
1336 	NL80211_CMD_TDLS_CANCEL_CHANNEL_SWITCH,
1337 
1338 	NL80211_CMD_WIPHY_REG_CHANGE,
1339 
1340 	NL80211_CMD_ABORT_SCAN,
1341 
1342 	NL80211_CMD_START_NAN,
1343 	NL80211_CMD_STOP_NAN,
1344 	NL80211_CMD_ADD_NAN_FUNCTION,
1345 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_NAN_FUNCTION,
1346 	NL80211_CMD_CHANGE_NAN_CONFIG,
1347 	NL80211_CMD_NAN_MATCH,
1348 
1349 	NL80211_CMD_SET_MULTICAST_TO_UNICAST,
1350 
1351 	NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_CONNECT_PARAMS,
1352 
1353 	NL80211_CMD_SET_PMK,
1354 	NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMK,
1355 
1356 	NL80211_CMD_PORT_AUTHORIZED,
1357 
1358 	NL80211_CMD_RELOAD_REGDB,
1359 
1360 	NL80211_CMD_EXTERNAL_AUTH,
1361 
1362 	NL80211_CMD_STA_OPMODE_CHANGED,
1363 
1364 	NL80211_CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME,
1365 
1366 	NL80211_CMD_GET_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS,
1367 
1368 	NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_START,
1369 	NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_RESULT,
1370 	NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_COMPLETE,
1371 
1372 	NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_RADAR,
1373 
1374 	NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_OWE_INFO,
1375 
1376 	NL80211_CMD_PROBE_MESH_LINK,
1377 
1378 	NL80211_CMD_SET_TID_CONFIG,
1379 
1380 	/* add new commands above here */
1381 
1382 	/* used to define NL80211_CMD_MAX below */
1383 	__NL80211_CMD_AFTER_LAST,
1384 	NL80211_CMD_MAX = __NL80211_CMD_AFTER_LAST - 1
1385 };
1386 
1387 /*
1388  * Allow user space programs to use #ifdef on new commands by defining them
1389  * here
1390  */
1391 #define NL80211_CMD_SET_BSS NL80211_CMD_SET_BSS
1392 #define NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE
1393 #define NL80211_CMD_REG_CHANGE NL80211_CMD_REG_CHANGE
1394 #define NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE
1395 #define NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE
1396 #define NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE
1397 #define NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE
1398 #define NL80211_CMD_REG_BEACON_HINT NL80211_CMD_REG_BEACON_HINT
1399 
1400 #define NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS
1401 
1402 /* source-level API compatibility */
1403 #define NL80211_CMD_GET_MESH_PARAMS NL80211_CMD_GET_MESH_CONFIG
1404 #define NL80211_CMD_SET_MESH_PARAMS NL80211_CMD_SET_MESH_CONFIG
1405 #define NL80211_MESH_SETUP_VENDOR_PATH_SEL_IE NL80211_MESH_SETUP_IE
1406 
1407 /**
1408  * enum nl80211_attrs - nl80211 netlink attributes
1409  *
1410  * @NL80211_ATTR_UNSPEC: unspecified attribute to catch errors
1411  *
1412  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY: index of wiphy to operate on, cf.
1413  *	/sys/class/ieee80211/<phyname>/index
1414  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_NAME: wiphy name (used for renaming)
1415  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TXQ_PARAMS: a nested array of TX queue parameters
1416  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ: frequency of the selected channel in MHz,
1417  *	defines the channel together with the (deprecated)
1418  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_CHANNEL_TYPE attribute or the attributes
1419  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CHANNEL_WIDTH and if needed %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1
1420  *	and %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ2
1421  * @NL80211_ATTR_CHANNEL_WIDTH: u32 attribute containing one of the values
1422  *	of &enum nl80211_chan_width, describing the channel width. See the
1423  *	documentation of the enum for more information.
1424  * @NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1: Center frequency of the first part of the
1425  *	channel, used for anything but 20 MHz bandwidth
1426  * @NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ2: Center frequency of the second part of the
1427  *	channel, used only for 80+80 MHz bandwidth
1428  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_CHANNEL_TYPE: included with NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ
1429  *	if HT20 or HT40 are to be used (i.e., HT disabled if not included):
1430  *	NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT = HT not allowed (i.e., same as not including
1431  *		this attribute)
1432  *	NL80211_CHAN_HT20 = HT20 only
1433  *	NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS = secondary channel is below the primary channel
1434  *	NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS = secondary channel is above the primary channel
1435  *	This attribute is now deprecated.
1436  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_SHORT: TX retry limit for frames whose length is
1437  *	less than or equal to the RTS threshold; allowed range: 1..255;
1438  *	dot11ShortRetryLimit; u8
1439  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_LONG: TX retry limit for frames whose length is
1440  *	greater than the RTS threshold; allowed range: 1..255;
1441  *	dot11ShortLongLimit; u8
1442  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FRAG_THRESHOLD: fragmentation threshold, i.e., maximum
1443  *	length in octets for frames; allowed range: 256..8000, disable
1444  *	fragmentation with (u32)-1; dot11FragmentationThreshold; u32
1445  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RTS_THRESHOLD: RTS threshold (TX frames with length
1446  *	larger than or equal to this use RTS/CTS handshake); allowed range:
1447  *	0..65536, disable with (u32)-1; dot11RTSThreshold; u32
1448  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_COVERAGE_CLASS: Coverage Class as defined by IEEE 802.11
1449  *	section 7.3.2.9; dot11CoverageClass; u8
1450  *
1451  * @NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX: network interface index of the device to operate on
1452  * @NL80211_ATTR_IFNAME: network interface name
1453  * @NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE: type of virtual interface, see &enum nl80211_iftype
1454  *
1455  * @NL80211_ATTR_WDEV: wireless device identifier, used for pseudo-devices
1456  *	that don't have a netdev (u64)
1457  *
1458  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAC: MAC address (various uses)
1459  *
1460  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DATA: (temporal) key data; for TKIP this consists of
1461  *	16 bytes encryption key followed by 8 bytes each for TX and RX MIC
1462  *	keys
1463  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX: key ID (u8, 0-3)
1464  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_CIPHER: key cipher suite (u32, as defined by IEEE 802.11
1465  *	section 7.3.2.25.1, e.g. 0x000FAC04)
1466  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_SEQ: transmit key sequence number (IV/PN) for TKIP and
1467  *	CCMP keys, each six bytes in little endian
1468  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT: Flag attribute indicating the key is default key
1469  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT_MGMT: Flag attribute indicating the key is the
1470  *	default management key
1471  * @NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES_PAIRWISE: For crypto settings for connect or
1472  *	other commands, indicates which pairwise cipher suites are used
1473  * @NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITE_GROUP: For crypto settings for connect or
1474  *	other commands, indicates which group cipher suite is used
1475  *
1476  * @NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_INTERVAL: beacon interval in TU
1477  * @NL80211_ATTR_DTIM_PERIOD: DTIM period for beaconing
1478  * @NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_HEAD: portion of the beacon before the TIM IE
1479  * @NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_TAIL: portion of the beacon after the TIM IE
1480  *
1481  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_AID: Association ID for the station (u16)
1482  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_FLAGS: flags, nested element with NLA_FLAG attributes of
1483  *	&enum nl80211_sta_flags (deprecated, use %NL80211_ATTR_STA_FLAGS2)
1484  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_LISTEN_INTERVAL: listen interval as defined by
1485  *	IEEE 802.11 7.3.1.6 (u16).
1486  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_RATES: supported rates, array of supported
1487  *	rates as defined by IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.2 but without the length
1488  *	restriction (at most %NL80211_MAX_SUPP_RATES).
1489  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_VLAN: interface index of VLAN interface to move station
1490  *	to, or the AP interface the station was originally added to to.
1491  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_INFO: information about a station, part of station info
1492  *	given for %NL80211_CMD_GET_STATION, nested attribute containing
1493  *	info as possible, see &enum nl80211_sta_info.
1494  *
1495  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_BANDS: Information about an operating bands,
1496  *	consisting of a nested array.
1497  *
1498  * @NL80211_ATTR_MESH_ID: mesh id (1-32 bytes).
1499  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_PLINK_ACTION: action to perform on the mesh peer link
1500  *	(see &enum nl80211_plink_action).
1501  * @NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_NEXT_HOP: MAC address of the next hop for a mesh path.
1502  * @NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_INFO: information about a mesh_path, part of mesh path
1503  * 	info given for %NL80211_CMD_GET_MPATH, nested attribute described at
1504  *	&enum nl80211_mpath_info.
1505  *
1506  * @NL80211_ATTR_MNTR_FLAGS: flags, nested element with NLA_FLAG attributes of
1507  *      &enum nl80211_mntr_flags.
1508  *
1509  * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_ALPHA2: an ISO-3166-alpha2 country code for which the
1510  * 	current regulatory domain should be set to or is already set to.
1511  * 	For example, 'CR', for Costa Rica. This attribute is used by the kernel
1512  * 	to query the CRDA to retrieve one regulatory domain. This attribute can
1513  * 	also be used by userspace to query the kernel for the currently set
1514  * 	regulatory domain. We chose an alpha2 as that is also used by the
1515  * 	IEEE-802.11 country information element to identify a country.
1516  * 	Users can also simply ask the wireless core to set regulatory domain
1517  * 	to a specific alpha2.
1518  * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULES: a nested array of regulatory domain regulatory
1519  *	rules.
1520  *
1521  * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_CTS_PROT: whether CTS protection is enabled (u8, 0 or 1)
1522  * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SHORT_PREAMBLE: whether short preamble is enabled
1523  *	(u8, 0 or 1)
1524  * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME: whether short slot time enabled
1525  *	(u8, 0 or 1)
1526  * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_BASIC_RATES: basic rates, array of basic
1527  *	rates in format defined by IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.2 but without the length
1528  *	restriction (at most %NL80211_MAX_SUPP_RATES).
1529  *
1530  * @NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY: HT Capability information element (from
1531  *	association request when used with NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION)
1532  *
1533  * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_IFTYPES: nested attribute containing all
1534  *	supported interface types, each a flag attribute with the number
1535  *	of the interface mode.
1536  *
1537  * @NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE: Management frame subtype for
1538  *	%NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE.
1539  *
1540  * @NL80211_ATTR_IE: Information element(s) data (used, e.g., with
1541  *	%NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE).
1542  *
1543  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCAN_SSIDS: number of SSIDs you can scan with
1544  *	a single scan request, a wiphy attribute.
1545  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCHED_SCAN_SSIDS: number of SSIDs you can
1546  *	scan with a single scheduled scan request, a wiphy attribute.
1547  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_IE_LEN: maximum length of information elements
1548  *	that can be added to a scan request
1549  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCHED_SCAN_IE_LEN: maximum length of information
1550  *	elements that can be added to a scheduled scan request
1551  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_MATCH_SETS: maximum number of sets that can be
1552  *	used with @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH, a wiphy attribute.
1553  *
1554  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES: nested attribute with frequencies (in MHz)
1555  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SSIDS: nested attribute with SSIDs, leave out for passive
1556  *	scanning and include a zero-length SSID (wildcard) for wildcard scan
1557  * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS: scan result BSS
1558  *
1559  * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_INITIATOR: indicates who requested the regulatory domain
1560  * 	currently in effect. This could be any of the %NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_*
1561  * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_TYPE: indicates the type of the regulatory domain currently
1562  * 	set. This can be one of the nl80211_reg_type (%NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_*)
1563  *
1564  * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_COMMANDS: wiphy attribute that specifies
1565  *	an array of command numbers (i.e. a mapping index to command number)
1566  *	that the driver for the given wiphy supports.
1567  *
1568  * @NL80211_ATTR_FRAME: frame data (binary attribute), including frame header
1569  *	and body, but not FCS; used, e.g., with NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE and
1570  *	NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE events
1571  * @NL80211_ATTR_SSID: SSID (binary attribute, 0..32 octets)
1572  * @NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE: AuthenticationType, see &enum nl80211_auth_type,
1573  *	represented as a u32
1574  * @NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE: ReasonCode for %NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE and
1575  *	%NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE, u16
1576  *
1577  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_TYPE: Key Type, see &enum nl80211_key_type, represented as
1578  *	a u32
1579  *
1580  * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_BEFORE: A channel which has suffered a regulatory change
1581  * 	due to considerations from a beacon hint. This attribute reflects
1582  * 	the state of the channel _before_ the beacon hint processing. This
1583  * 	attributes consists of a nested attribute containing
1584  * 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_*
1585  * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_AFTER: A channel which has suffered a regulatory change
1586  * 	due to considerations from a beacon hint. This attribute reflects
1587  * 	the state of the channel _after_ the beacon hint processing. This
1588  * 	attributes consists of a nested attribute containing
1589  * 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_*
1590  *
1591  * @NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES: a set of u32 values indicating the supported
1592  *	cipher suites
1593  *
1594  * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_FIXED: a flag indicating the IBSS should not try to look
1595  *	for other networks on different channels
1596  *
1597  * @NL80211_ATTR_TIMED_OUT: a flag indicating than an operation timed out; this
1598  *	is used, e.g., with %NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE event
1599  *
1600  * @NL80211_ATTR_USE_MFP: Whether management frame protection (IEEE 802.11w) is
1601  *	used for the association (&enum nl80211_mfp, represented as a u32);
1602  *	this attribute can be used with %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE and
1603  *	%NL80211_CMD_CONNECT requests. %NL80211_MFP_OPTIONAL is not allowed for
1604  *	%NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE since user space SME is expected and hence, it
1605  *	must have decided whether to use management frame protection or not.
1606  *	Setting %NL80211_MFP_OPTIONAL with a %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT request will
1607  *	let the driver (or the firmware) decide whether to use MFP or not.
1608  *
1609  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_FLAGS2: Attribute containing a
1610  *	&struct nl80211_sta_flag_update.
1611  *
1612  * @NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT: A flag indicating whether user space controls
1613  *	IEEE 802.1X port, i.e., sets/clears %NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED, in
1614  *	station mode. If the flag is included in %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE
1615  *	request, the driver will assume that the port is unauthorized until
1616  *	authorized by user space. Otherwise, port is marked authorized by
1617  *	default in station mode.
1618  * @NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE: A 16-bit value indicating the
1619  *	ethertype that will be used for key negotiation. It can be
1620  *	specified with the associate and connect commands. If it is not
1621  *	specified, the value defaults to 0x888E (PAE, 802.1X). This
1622  *	attribute is also used as a flag in the wiphy information to
1623  *	indicate that protocols other than PAE are supported.
1624  * @NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_ENCRYPT: When included along with
1625  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE, indicates that the custom
1626  *	ethertype frames used for key negotiation must not be encrypted.
1627  * @NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211: A flag indicating whether control
1628  *	port frames (e.g. of type given in %NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE)
1629  *	will be sent directly to the network interface or sent via the NL80211
1630  *	socket.  If this attribute is missing, then legacy behavior of sending
1631  *	control port frames directly to the network interface is used.  If the
1632  *	flag is included, then control port frames are sent over NL80211 instead
1633  *	using %CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME.  If control port routing over NL80211 is
1634  *	to be used then userspace must also use the %NL80211_ATTR_SOCKET_OWNER
1635  *	flag.
1636  *
1637  * @NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA: Testmode data blob, passed through to the driver.
1638  *	We recommend using nested, driver-specific attributes within this.
1639  *
1640  * @NL80211_ATTR_DISCONNECTED_BY_AP: A flag indicating that the DISCONNECT
1641  *	event was due to the AP disconnecting the station, and not due to
1642  *	a local disconnect request.
1643  * @NL80211_ATTR_STATUS_CODE: StatusCode for the %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT
1644  *	event (u16)
1645  * @NL80211_ATTR_PRIVACY: Flag attribute, used with connect(), indicating
1646  *	that protected APs should be used. This is also used with NEW_BEACON to
1647  *	indicate that the BSS is to use protection.
1648  *
1649  * @NL80211_ATTR_CIPHERS_PAIRWISE: Used with CONNECT, ASSOCIATE, and NEW_BEACON
1650  *	to indicate which unicast key ciphers will be used with the connection
1651  *	(an array of u32).
1652  * @NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_GROUP: Used with CONNECT, ASSOCIATE, and NEW_BEACON to
1653  *	indicate which group key cipher will be used with the connection (a
1654  *	u32).
1655  * @NL80211_ATTR_WPA_VERSIONS: Used with CONNECT, ASSOCIATE, and NEW_BEACON to
1656  *	indicate which WPA version(s) the AP we want to associate with is using
1657  *	(a u32 with flags from &enum nl80211_wpa_versions).
1658  * @NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES: Used with CONNECT, ASSOCIATE, and NEW_BEACON to
1659  *	indicate which key management algorithm(s) to use (an array of u32).
1660  *	This attribute is also sent in response to @NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY,
1661  *	indicating the supported AKM suites, intended for specific drivers which
1662  *	implement SME and have constraints on which AKMs are supported and also
1663  *	the cases where an AKM support is offloaded to the driver/firmware.
1664  *	If there is no such notification from the driver, user space should
1665  *	assume the driver supports all the AKM suites.
1666  *
1667  * @NL80211_ATTR_REQ_IE: (Re)association request information elements as
1668  *	sent out by the card, for ROAM and successful CONNECT events.
1669  * @NL80211_ATTR_RESP_IE: (Re)association response information elements as
1670  *	sent by peer, for ROAM and successful CONNECT events.
1671  *
1672  * @NL80211_ATTR_PREV_BSSID: previous BSSID, to be used in ASSOCIATE and CONNECT
1673  *	commands to specify a request to reassociate within an ESS, i.e., to use
1674  *	Reassociate Request frame (with the value of this attribute in the
1675  *	Current AP address field) instead of Association Request frame which is
1676  *	used for the initial association to an ESS.
1677  *
1678  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY: key information in a nested attribute with
1679  *	%NL80211_KEY_* sub-attributes
1680  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEYS: array of keys for static WEP keys for connect()
1681  *	and join_ibss(), key information is in a nested attribute each
1682  *	with %NL80211_KEY_* sub-attributes
1683  *
1684  * @NL80211_ATTR_PID: Process ID of a network namespace.
1685  *
1686  * @NL80211_ATTR_GENERATION: Used to indicate consistent snapshots for
1687  *	dumps. This number increases whenever the object list being
1688  *	dumped changes, and as such userspace can verify that it has
1689  *	obtained a complete and consistent snapshot by verifying that
1690  *	all dump messages contain the same generation number. If it
1691  *	changed then the list changed and the dump should be repeated
1692  *	completely from scratch.
1693  *
1694  * @NL80211_ATTR_4ADDR: Use 4-address frames on a virtual interface
1695  *
1696  * @NL80211_ATTR_SURVEY_INFO: survey information about a channel, part of
1697  *      the survey response for %NL80211_CMD_GET_SURVEY, nested attribute
1698  *      containing info as possible, see &enum survey_info.
1699  *
1700  * @NL80211_ATTR_PMKID: PMK material for PMKSA caching.
1701  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_PMKIDS: maximum number of PMKIDs a firmware can
1702  *	cache, a wiphy attribute.
1703  *
1704  * @NL80211_ATTR_DURATION: Duration of an operation in milliseconds, u32.
1705  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL_DURATION: Device attribute that
1706  *	specifies the maximum duration that can be requested with the
1707  *	remain-on-channel operation, in milliseconds, u32.
1708  *
1709  * @NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE: Generic 64-bit cookie to identify objects.
1710  *
1711  * @NL80211_ATTR_TX_RATES: Nested set of attributes
1712  *	(enum nl80211_tx_rate_attributes) describing TX rates per band. The
1713  *	enum nl80211_band value is used as the index (nla_type() of the nested
1714  *	data. If a band is not included, it will be configured to allow all
1715  *	rates based on negotiated supported rates information. This attribute
1716  *	is used with %NL80211_CMD_SET_TX_BITRATE_MASK and with starting AP,
1717  *	and joining mesh networks (not IBSS yet). In the later case, it must
1718  *	specify just a single bitrate, which is to be used for the beacon.
1719  *	The driver must also specify support for this with the extended
1720  *	features NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_LEGACY,
1721  *	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HT and
1722  *	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_VHT.
1723  *
1724  * @NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_MATCH: A binary attribute which typically must contain
1725  *	at least one byte, currently used with @NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME.
1726  * @NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_TYPE: A u16 indicating the frame type/subtype for the
1727  *	@NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME command.
1728  * @NL80211_ATTR_TX_FRAME_TYPES: wiphy capability attribute, which is a
1729  *	nested attribute of %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_TYPE attributes, containing
1730  *	information about which frame types can be transmitted with
1731  *	%NL80211_CMD_FRAME.
1732  * @NL80211_ATTR_RX_FRAME_TYPES: wiphy capability attribute, which is a
1733  *	nested attribute of %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_TYPE attributes, containing
1734  *	information about which frame types can be registered for RX.
1735  *
1736  * @NL80211_ATTR_ACK: Flag attribute indicating that the frame was
1737  *	acknowledged by the recipient.
1738  *
1739  * @NL80211_ATTR_PS_STATE: powersave state, using &enum nl80211_ps_state values.
1740  *
1741  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM: connection quality monitor configuration in a
1742  *	nested attribute with %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_* sub-attributes.
1743  *
1744  * @NL80211_ATTR_LOCAL_STATE_CHANGE: Flag attribute to indicate that a command
1745  *	is requesting a local authentication/association state change without
1746  *	invoking actual management frame exchange. This can be used with
1747  *	NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE, NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE,
1748  *	NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE.
1749  *
1750  * @NL80211_ATTR_AP_ISOLATE: (AP mode) Do not forward traffic between stations
1751  *	connected to this BSS.
1752  *
1753  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TX_POWER_SETTING: Transmit power setting type. See
1754  *      &enum nl80211_tx_power_setting for possible values.
1755  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TX_POWER_LEVEL: Transmit power level in signed mBm units.
1756  *      This is used in association with @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TX_POWER_SETTING
1757  *      for non-automatic settings.
1758  *
1759  * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_IBSS_RSN: The device supports IBSS RSN, which mostly
1760  *	means support for per-station GTKs.
1761  *
1762  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX: Bitmap of allowed antennas for transmitting.
1763  *	This can be used to mask out antennas which are not attached or should
1764  *	not be used for transmitting. If an antenna is not selected in this
1765  *	bitmap the hardware is not allowed to transmit on this antenna.
1766  *
1767  *	Each bit represents one antenna, starting with antenna 1 at the first
1768  *	bit. Depending on which antennas are selected in the bitmap, 802.11n
1769  *	drivers can derive which chainmasks to use (if all antennas belonging to
1770  *	a particular chain are disabled this chain should be disabled) and if
1771  *	a chain has diversity antennas wether diversity should be used or not.
1772  *	HT capabilities (STBC, TX Beamforming, Antenna selection) can be
1773  *	derived from the available chains after applying the antenna mask.
1774  *	Non-802.11n drivers can derive wether to use diversity or not.
1775  *	Drivers may reject configurations or RX/TX mask combinations they cannot
1776  *	support by returning -EINVAL.
1777  *
1778  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_RX: Bitmap of allowed antennas for receiving.
1779  *	This can be used to mask out antennas which are not attached or should
1780  *	not be used for receiving. If an antenna is not selected in this bitmap
1781  *	the hardware should not be configured to receive on this antenna.
1782  *	For a more detailed description see @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX.
1783  *
1784  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_AVAIL_TX: Bitmap of antennas which are available
1785  *	for configuration as TX antennas via the above parameters.
1786  *
1787  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_AVAIL_RX: Bitmap of antennas which are available
1788  *	for configuration as RX antennas via the above parameters.
1789  *
1790  * @NL80211_ATTR_MCAST_RATE: Multicast tx rate (in 100 kbps) for IBSS
1791  *
1792  * @NL80211_ATTR_OFFCHANNEL_TX_OK: For management frame TX, the frame may be
1793  *	transmitted on another channel when the channel given doesn't match
1794  *	the current channel. If the current channel doesn't match and this
1795  *	flag isn't set, the frame will be rejected. This is also used as an
1796  *	nl80211 capability flag.
1797  *
1798  * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_HT_OPMODE: HT operation mode (u16)
1799  *
1800  * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES: A nested attribute containing flags
1801  *	attributes, specifying what a key should be set as default as.
1802  *	See &enum nl80211_key_default_types.
1803  *
1804  * @NL80211_ATTR_MESH_SETUP: Optional mesh setup parameters.  These cannot be
1805  *	changed once the mesh is active.
1806  * @NL80211_ATTR_MESH_CONFIG: Mesh configuration parameters, a nested attribute
1807  *	containing attributes from &enum nl80211_meshconf_params.
1808  * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_MESH_AUTH: Currently, this means the underlying driver
1809  *	allows auth frames in a mesh to be passed to userspace for processing via
1810  *	the @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH flag.
1811  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_PLINK_STATE: The state of a mesh peer link as defined in
1812  *	&enum nl80211_plink_state. Used when userspace is driving the peer link
1813  *	management state machine.  @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AMPE or
1814  *	@NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_MPM must be enabled.
1815  *
1816  * @NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS_SUPPORTED: indicates, as part of the wiphy
1817  *	capabilities, the supported WoWLAN triggers
1818  * @NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS: used by %NL80211_CMD_SET_WOWLAN to
1819  *	indicate which WoW triggers should be enabled. This is also
1820  *	used by %NL80211_CMD_GET_WOWLAN to get the currently enabled WoWLAN
1821  *	triggers.
1822  *
1823  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_INTERVAL: Interval between scheduled scan
1824  *	cycles, in msecs.
1825  *
1826  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH: Nested attribute with one or more
1827  *	sets of attributes to match during scheduled scans.  Only BSSs
1828  *	that match any of the sets will be reported.  These are
1829  *	pass-thru filter rules.
1830  *	For a match to succeed, the BSS must match all attributes of a
1831  *	set.  Since not every hardware supports matching all types of
1832  *	attributes, there is no guarantee that the reported BSSs are
1833  *	fully complying with the match sets and userspace needs to be
1834  *	able to ignore them by itself.
1835  *	Thus, the implementation is somewhat hardware-dependent, but
1836  *	this is only an optimization and the userspace application
1837  *	needs to handle all the non-filtered results anyway.
1838  *	If the match attributes don't make sense when combined with
1839  *	the values passed in @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SSIDS (eg. if an SSID
1840  *	is included in the probe request, but the match attributes
1841  *	will never let it go through), -EINVAL may be returned.
1842  *	If omitted, no filtering is done.
1843  *
1844  * @NL80211_ATTR_INTERFACE_COMBINATIONS: Nested attribute listing the supported
1845  *	interface combinations. In each nested item, it contains attributes
1846  *	defined in &enum nl80211_if_combination_attrs.
1847  * @NL80211_ATTR_SOFTWARE_IFTYPES: Nested attribute (just like
1848  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_IFTYPES) containing the interface types that
1849  *	are managed in software: interfaces of these types aren't subject to
1850  *	any restrictions in their number or combinations.
1851  *
1852  * @NL80211_ATTR_REKEY_DATA: nested attribute containing the information
1853  *	necessary for GTK rekeying in the device, see &enum nl80211_rekey_data.
1854  *
1855  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SUPP_RATES: rates per to be advertised as supported in scan,
1856  *	nested array attribute containing an entry for each band, with the entry
1857  *	being a list of supported rates as defined by IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.2 but
1858  *	without the length restriction (at most %NL80211_MAX_SUPP_RATES).
1859  *
1860  * @NL80211_ATTR_HIDDEN_SSID: indicates whether SSID is to be hidden from Beacon
1861  *	and Probe Response (when response to wildcard Probe Request); see
1862  *	&enum nl80211_hidden_ssid, represented as a u32
1863  *
1864  * @NL80211_ATTR_IE_PROBE_RESP: Information element(s) for Probe Response frame.
1865  *	This is used with %NL80211_CMD_NEW_BEACON and %NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON to
1866  *	provide extra IEs (e.g., WPS/P2P IE) into Probe Response frames when the
1867  *	driver (or firmware) replies to Probe Request frames.
1868  * @NL80211_ATTR_IE_ASSOC_RESP: Information element(s) for (Re)Association
1869  *	Response frames. This is used with %NL80211_CMD_NEW_BEACON and
1870  *	%NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON to provide extra IEs (e.g., WPS/P2P IE) into
1871  *	(Re)Association Response frames when the driver (or firmware) replies to
1872  *	(Re)Association Request frames.
1873  *
1874  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_WME: Nested attribute containing the wme configuration
1875  *	of the station, see &enum nl80211_sta_wme_attr.
1876  * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_AP_UAPSD: the device supports uapsd when working
1877  *	as AP.
1878  *
1879  * @NL80211_ATTR_ROAM_SUPPORT: Indicates whether the firmware is capable of
1880  *	roaming to another AP in the same ESS if the signal lever is low.
1881  *
1882  * @NL80211_ATTR_PMKSA_CANDIDATE: Nested attribute containing the PMKSA caching
1883  *	candidate information, see &enum nl80211_pmksa_candidate_attr.
1884  *
1885  * @NL80211_ATTR_TX_NO_CCK_RATE: Indicates whether to use CCK rate or not
1886  *	for management frames transmission. In order to avoid p2p probe/action
1887  *	frames are being transmitted at CCK rate in 2GHz band, the user space
1888  *	applications use this attribute.
1889  *	This attribute is used with %NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN and
1890  *	%NL80211_CMD_FRAME commands.
1891  *
1892  * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_ACTION: Low level TDLS action code (e.g. link setup
1893  *	request, link setup confirm, link teardown, etc.). Values are
1894  *	described in the TDLS (802.11z) specification.
1895  * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_DIALOG_TOKEN: Non-zero token for uniquely identifying a
1896  *	TDLS conversation between two devices.
1897  * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_OPERATION: High level TDLS operation; see
1898  *	&enum nl80211_tdls_operation, represented as a u8.
1899  * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_SUPPORT: A flag indicating the device can operate
1900  *	as a TDLS peer sta.
1901  * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP: The TDLS discovery/setup and teardown
1902  *	procedures should be performed by sending TDLS packets via
1903  *	%NL80211_CMD_TDLS_MGMT. Otherwise %NL80211_CMD_TDLS_OPER should be
1904  *	used for asking the driver to perform a TDLS operation.
1905  *
1906  * @NL80211_ATTR_DEVICE_AP_SME: This u32 attribute may be listed for devices
1907  *	that have AP support to indicate that they have the AP SME integrated
1908  *	with support for the features listed in this attribute, see
1909  *	&enum nl80211_ap_sme_features.
1910  *
1911  * @NL80211_ATTR_DONT_WAIT_FOR_ACK: Used with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME, this tells
1912  *	the driver to not wait for an acknowledgement. Note that due to this,
1913  *	it will also not give a status callback nor return a cookie. This is
1914  *	mostly useful for probe responses to save airtime.
1915  *
1916  * @NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS: This u32 attribute contains flags from
1917  *	&enum nl80211_feature_flags and is advertised in wiphy information.
1918  * @NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD: Indicates that the HW responds to probe
1919  *	requests while operating in AP-mode.
1920  *	This attribute holds a bitmap of the supported protocols for
1921  *	offloading (see &enum nl80211_probe_resp_offload_support_attr).
1922  *
1923  * @NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP: Probe Response template data. Contains the entire
1924  *	probe-response frame. The DA field in the 802.11 header is zero-ed out,
1925  *	to be filled by the FW.
1926  * @NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_HT:  Force HT capable interfaces to disable
1927  *      this feature.  Currently, only supported in mac80211 drivers.
1928  * @NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY_MASK: Specify which bits of the
1929  *      ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY to which attention should be paid.
1930  *      Currently, only mac80211 NICs support this feature.
1931  *      The values that may be configured are:
1932  *       MCS rates, MAX-AMSDU, HT-20-40 and HT_CAP_SGI_40
1933  *       AMPDU density and AMPDU factor.
1934  *      All values are treated as suggestions and may be ignored
1935  *      by the driver as required.  The actual values may be seen in
1936  *      the station debugfs ht_caps file.
1937  *
1938  * @NL80211_ATTR_DFS_REGION: region for regulatory rules which this country
1939  *    abides to when initiating radiation on DFS channels. A country maps
1940  *    to one DFS region.
1941  *
1942  * @NL80211_ATTR_NOACK_MAP: This u16 bitmap contains the No Ack Policy of
1943  *      up to 16 TIDs.
1944  *
1945  * @NL80211_ATTR_INACTIVITY_TIMEOUT: timeout value in seconds, this can be
1946  *	used by the drivers which has MLME in firmware and does not have support
1947  *	to report per station tx/rx activity to free up the station entry from
1948  *	the list. This needs to be used when the driver advertises the
1949  *	capability to timeout the stations.
1950  *
1951  * @NL80211_ATTR_RX_SIGNAL_DBM: signal strength in dBm (as a 32-bit int);
1952  *	this attribute is (depending on the driver capabilities) added to
1953  *	received frames indicated with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME.
1954  *
1955  * @NL80211_ATTR_BG_SCAN_PERIOD: Background scan period in seconds
1956  *      or 0 to disable background scan.
1957  *
1958  * @NL80211_ATTR_USER_REG_HINT_TYPE: type of regulatory hint passed from
1959  *	userspace. If unset it is assumed the hint comes directly from
1960  *	a user. If set code could specify exactly what type of source
1961  *	was used to provide the hint. For the different types of
1962  *	allowed user regulatory hints see nl80211_user_reg_hint_type.
1963  *
1964  * @NL80211_ATTR_CONN_FAILED_REASON: The reason for which AP has rejected
1965  *	the connection request from a station. nl80211_connect_failed_reason
1966  *	enum has different reasons of connection failure.
1967  *
1968  * @NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_DATA: Fields and elements in Authentication frames.
1969  *	This contains the authentication frame body (non-IE and IE data),
1970  *	excluding the Authentication algorithm number, i.e., starting at the
1971  *	Authentication transaction sequence number field. It is used with
1972  *	authentication algorithms that need special fields to be added into
1973  *	the frames (SAE and FILS). Currently, only the SAE cases use the
1974  *	initial two fields (Authentication transaction sequence number and
1975  *	Status code). However, those fields are included in the attribute data
1976  *	for all authentication algorithms to keep the attribute definition
1977  *	consistent.
1978  *
1979  * @NL80211_ATTR_VHT_CAPABILITY: VHT Capability information element (from
1980  *	association request when used with NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION)
1981  *
1982  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FLAGS: scan request control flags (u32)
1983  *
1984  * @NL80211_ATTR_P2P_CTWINDOW: P2P GO Client Traffic Window (u8), used with
1985  *	the START_AP and SET_BSS commands
1986  * @NL80211_ATTR_P2P_OPPPS: P2P GO opportunistic PS (u8), used with the
1987  *	START_AP and SET_BSS commands. This can have the values 0 or 1;
1988  *	if not given in START_AP 0 is assumed, if not given in SET_BSS
1989  *	no change is made.
1990  *
1991  * @NL80211_ATTR_LOCAL_MESH_POWER_MODE: local mesh STA link-specific power mode
1992  *	defined in &enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode.
1993  *
1994  * @NL80211_ATTR_ACL_POLICY: ACL policy, see &enum nl80211_acl_policy,
1995  *	carried in a u32 attribute
1996  *
1997  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ADDRS: Array of nested MAC addresses, used for
1998  *	MAC ACL.
1999  *
2000  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ACL_MAX: u32 attribute to advertise the maximum
2001  *	number of MAC addresses that a device can support for MAC
2002  *	ACL.
2003  *
2004  * @NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_EVENT: Type of radar event for notification to userspace,
2005  *	contains a value of enum nl80211_radar_event (u32).
2006  *
2007  * @NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA: 802.11 extended capabilities that the kernel driver
2008  *	has and handles. The format is the same as the IE contents. See
2009  *	802.11-2012 8.4.2.29 for more information.
2010  * @NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA_MASK: Extended capabilities that the kernel driver
2011  *	has set in the %NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA value, for multibit fields.
2012  *
2013  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_CAPABILITY: Station capabilities (u16) are advertised to
2014  *	the driver, e.g., to enable TDLS power save (PU-APSD).
2015  *
2016  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_EXT_CAPABILITY: Station extended capabilities are
2017  *	advertised to the driver, e.g., to enable TDLS off channel operations
2018  *	and PU-APSD.
2019  *
2020  * @NL80211_ATTR_PROTOCOL_FEATURES: global nl80211 feature flags, see
2021  *	&enum nl80211_protocol_features, the attribute is a u32.
2022  *
2023  * @NL80211_ATTR_SPLIT_WIPHY_DUMP: flag attribute, userspace supports
2024  *	receiving the data for a single wiphy split across multiple
2025  *	messages, given with wiphy dump message
2026  *
2027  * @NL80211_ATTR_MDID: Mobility Domain Identifier
2028  *
2029  * @NL80211_ATTR_IE_RIC: Resource Information Container Information
2030  *	Element
2031  *
2032  * @NL80211_ATTR_CRIT_PROT_ID: critical protocol identifier requiring increased
2033  *	reliability, see &enum nl80211_crit_proto_id (u16).
2034  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_CRIT_PROT_DURATION: duration in milliseconds in which
2035  *      the connection should have increased reliability (u16).
2036  *
2037  * @NL80211_ATTR_PEER_AID: Association ID for the peer TDLS station (u16).
2038  *	This is similar to @NL80211_ATTR_STA_AID but with a difference of being
2039  *	allowed to be used with the first @NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION command to
2040  *	update a TDLS peer STA entry.
2041  *
2042  * @NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE: Coalesce rule information.
2043  *
2044  * @NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_COUNT: u32 attribute specifying the number of TBTT's
2045  *	until the channel switch event.
2046  * @NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_BLOCK_TX: flag attribute specifying that transmission
2047  *	must be blocked on the current channel (before the channel switch
2048  *	operation).
2049  * @NL80211_ATTR_CSA_IES: Nested set of attributes containing the IE information
2050  *	for the time while performing a channel switch.
2051  * @NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFF_BEACON: An array of offsets (u16) to the channel
2052  *	switch counters in the beacons tail (%NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_TAIL).
2053  * @NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFF_PRESP: An array of offsets (u16) to the channel
2054  *	switch counters in the probe response (%NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP).
2055  *
2056  * @NL80211_ATTR_RXMGMT_FLAGS: flags for nl80211_send_mgmt(), u32.
2057  *	As specified in the &enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags.
2058  *
2059  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_CHANNELS: array of supported channels.
2060  *
2061  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_OPER_CLASSES: array of supported
2062  *      supported operating classes.
2063  *
2064  * @NL80211_ATTR_HANDLE_DFS: A flag indicating whether user space
2065  *	controls DFS operation in IBSS mode. If the flag is included in
2066  *	%NL80211_CMD_JOIN_IBSS request, the driver will allow use of DFS
2067  *	channels and reports radar events to userspace. Userspace is required
2068  *	to react to radar events, e.g. initiate a channel switch or leave the
2069  *	IBSS network.
2070  *
2071  * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_5_MHZ: A flag indicating that the device supports
2072  *	5 MHz channel bandwidth.
2073  * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_10_MHZ: A flag indicating that the device supports
2074  *	10 MHz channel bandwidth.
2075  *
2076  * @NL80211_ATTR_OPMODE_NOTIF: Operating mode field from Operating Mode
2077  *	Notification Element based on association request when used with
2078  *	%NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION or %NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION (only when
2079  *	%NL80211_FEATURE_FULL_AP_CLIENT_STATE is supported, or with TDLS);
2080  *	u8 attribute.
2081  *
2082  * @NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_ID: The vendor ID, either a 24-bit OUI or, if
2083  *	%NL80211_VENDOR_ID_IS_LINUX is set, a special Linux ID (not used yet)
2084  * @NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_SUBCMD: vendor sub-command
2085  * @NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA: data for the vendor command, if any; this
2086  *	attribute is also used for vendor command feature advertisement
2087  * @NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_EVENTS: used for event list advertising in the wiphy
2088  *	info, containing a nested array of possible events
2089  *
2090  * @NL80211_ATTR_QOS_MAP: IP DSCP mapping for Interworking QoS mapping. This
2091  *	data is in the format defined for the payload of the QoS Map Set element
2092  *	in IEEE Std 802.11-2012, 8.4.2.97.
2093  *
2094  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT: MAC address recommendation as initial BSS
2095  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_HINT: frequency of the recommended initial BSS
2096  *
2097  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_AP_ASSOC_STA: Device attribute that indicates how many
2098  *	associated stations are supported in AP mode (including P2P GO); u32.
2099  *	Since drivers may not have a fixed limit on the maximum number (e.g.,
2100  *	other concurrent operations may affect this), drivers are allowed to
2101  *	advertise values that cannot always be met. In such cases, an attempt
2102  *	to add a new station entry with @NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION may fail.
2103  *
2104  * @NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFFSETS_TX: An array of csa counter offsets (u16) which
2105  *	should be updated when the frame is transmitted.
2106  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_CSA_COUNTERS: U8 attribute used to advertise the maximum
2107  *	supported number of csa counters.
2108  *
2109  * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_PEER_CAPABILITY: flags for TDLS peer capabilities, u32.
2110  *	As specified in the &enum nl80211_tdls_peer_capability.
2111  *
2112  * @NL80211_ATTR_SOCKET_OWNER: Flag attribute, if set during interface
2113  *	creation then the new interface will be owned by the netlink socket
2114  *	that created it and will be destroyed when the socket is closed.
2115  *	If set during scheduled scan start then the new scan req will be
2116  *	owned by the netlink socket that created it and the scheduled scan will
2117  *	be stopped when the socket is closed.
2118  *	If set during configuration of regulatory indoor operation then the
2119  *	regulatory indoor configuration would be owned by the netlink socket
2120  *	that configured the indoor setting, and the indoor operation would be
2121  *	cleared when the socket is closed.
2122  *	If set during NAN interface creation, the interface will be destroyed
2123  *	if the socket is closed just like any other interface. Moreover, NAN
2124  *	notifications will be sent in unicast to that socket. Without this
2125  *	attribute, the notifications will be sent to the %NL80211_MCGRP_NAN
2126  *	multicast group.
2127  *	If set during %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE or %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT the
2128  *	station will deauthenticate when the socket is closed.
2129  *	If set during %NL80211_CMD_JOIN_IBSS the IBSS will be automatically
2130  *	torn down when the socket is closed.
2131  *	If set during %NL80211_CMD_JOIN_MESH the mesh setup will be
2132  *	automatically torn down when the socket is closed.
2133  *	If set during %NL80211_CMD_START_AP the AP will be automatically
2134  *	disabled when the socket is closed.
2135  *
2136  * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_INITIATOR: flag attribute indicating the current end is
2137  *	the TDLS link initiator.
2138  *
2139  * @NL80211_ATTR_USE_RRM: flag for indicating whether the current connection
2140  *	shall support Radio Resource Measurements (11k). This attribute can be
2141  *	used with %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE and %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT requests.
2142  *	User space applications are expected to use this flag only if the
2143  *	underlying device supports these minimal RRM features:
2144  *		%NL80211_FEATURE_DS_PARAM_SET_IE_IN_PROBES,
2145  *		%NL80211_FEATURE_QUIET,
2146  *	Or, if global RRM is supported, see:
2147  *		%NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_RRM
2148  *	If this flag is used, driver must add the Power Capabilities IE to the
2149  *	association request. In addition, it must also set the RRM capability
2150  *	flag in the association request's Capability Info field.
2151  *
2152  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_DYN_ACK: flag attribute used to enable ACK timeout
2153  *	estimation algorithm (dynack). In order to activate dynack
2154  *	%NL80211_FEATURE_ACKTO_ESTIMATION feature flag must be set by lower
2155  *	drivers to indicate dynack capability. Dynack is automatically disabled
2156  *	setting valid value for coverage class.
2157  *
2158  * @NL80211_ATTR_TSID: a TSID value (u8 attribute)
2159  * @NL80211_ATTR_USER_PRIO: user priority value (u8 attribute)
2160  * @NL80211_ATTR_ADMITTED_TIME: admitted time in units of 32 microseconds
2161  *	(per second) (u16 attribute)
2162  *
2163  * @NL80211_ATTR_SMPS_MODE: SMPS mode to use (ap mode). see
2164  *	&enum nl80211_smps_mode.
2165  *
2166  * @NL80211_ATTR_OPER_CLASS: operating class
2167  *
2168  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAC_MASK: MAC address mask
2169  *
2170  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_SELF_MANAGED_REG: flag attribute indicating this device
2171  *	is self-managing its regulatory information and any regulatory domain
2172  *	obtained from it is coming from the device's wiphy and not the global
2173  *	cfg80211 regdomain.
2174  *
2175  * @NL80211_ATTR_EXT_FEATURES: extended feature flags contained in a byte
2176  *	array. The feature flags are identified by their bit index (see &enum
2177  *	nl80211_ext_feature_index). The bit index is ordered starting at the
2178  *	least-significant bit of the first byte in the array, ie. bit index 0
2179  *	is located at bit 0 of byte 0. bit index 25 would be located at bit 1
2180  *	of byte 3 (u8 array).
2181  *
2182  * @NL80211_ATTR_SURVEY_RADIO_STATS: Request overall radio statistics to be
2183  *	returned along with other survey data. If set, @NL80211_CMD_GET_SURVEY
2184  *	may return a survey entry without a channel indicating global radio
2185  *	statistics (only some values are valid and make sense.)
2186  *	For devices that don't return such an entry even then, the information
2187  *	should be contained in the result as the sum of the respective counters
2188  *	over all channels.
2189  *
2190  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_DELAY: delay before the first cycle of a
2191  *	scheduled scan is started.  Or the delay before a WoWLAN
2192  *	net-detect scan is started, counting from the moment the
2193  *	system is suspended.  This value is a u32, in seconds.
2194 
2195  * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_INDOOR: flag attribute, if set indicates that the device
2196  *      is operating in an indoor environment.
2197  *
2198  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS: maximum number of scan plans for
2199  *	scheduled scan supported by the device (u32), a wiphy attribute.
2200  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_PLAN_INTERVAL: maximum interval (in seconds) for
2201  *	a scan plan (u32), a wiphy attribute.
2202  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_PLAN_ITERATIONS: maximum number of iterations in
2203  *	a scan plan (u32), a wiphy attribute.
2204  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS: a list of scan plans for scheduled scan.
2205  *	Each scan plan defines the number of scan iterations and the interval
2206  *	between scans. The last scan plan will always run infinitely,
2207  *	thus it must not specify the number of iterations, only the interval
2208  *	between scans. The scan plans are executed sequentially.
2209  *	Each scan plan is a nested attribute of &enum nl80211_sched_scan_plan.
2210  * @NL80211_ATTR_PBSS: flag attribute. If set it means operate
2211  *	in a PBSS. Specified in %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT to request
2212  *	connecting to a PCP, and in %NL80211_CMD_START_AP to start
2213  *	a PCP instead of AP. Relevant for DMG networks only.
2214  * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SELECT: nested attribute for driver supporting the
2215  *	BSS selection feature. When used with %NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY it contains
2216  *	attributes according &enum nl80211_bss_select_attr to indicate what
2217  *	BSS selection behaviours are supported. When used with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT
2218  *	it contains the behaviour-specific attribute containing the parameters for
2219  *	BSS selection to be done by driver and/or firmware.
2220  *
2221  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORT_P2P_PS: whether P2P PS mechanism supported
2222  *	or not. u8, one of the values of &enum nl80211_sta_p2p_ps_status
2223  *
2224  * @NL80211_ATTR_PAD: attribute used for padding for 64-bit alignment
2225  *
2226  * @NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE_EXT_CAPA: Nested attribute of the following attributes:
2227  *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE, %NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA,
2228  *	%NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA_MASK, to specify the extended capabilities per
2229  *	interface type.
2230  *
2231  * @NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_GROUP_DATA: array of 24 bytes that defines a MU-MIMO
2232  *	groupID for monitor mode.
2233  *	The first 8 bytes are a mask that defines the membership in each
2234  *	group (there are 64 groups, group 0 and 63 are reserved),
2235  *	each bit represents a group and set to 1 for being a member in
2236  *	that group and 0 for not being a member.
2237  *	The remaining 16 bytes define the position in each group: 2 bits for
2238  *	each group.
2239  *	(smaller group numbers represented on most significant bits and bigger
2240  *	group numbers on least significant bits.)
2241  *	This attribute is used only if all interfaces are in monitor mode.
2242  *	Set this attribute in order to monitor packets using the given MU-MIMO
2243  *	groupID data.
2244  *	to turn off that feature set all the bits of the groupID to zero.
2245  * @NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_FOLLOW_MAC_ADDR: mac address for the sniffer to follow
2246  *	when using MU-MIMO air sniffer.
2247  *	to turn that feature off set an invalid mac address
2248  *	(e.g. FF:FF:FF:FF:FF:FF)
2249  *
2250  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_START_TIME_TSF: The time at which the scan was actually
2251  *	started (u64). The time is the TSF of the BSS the interface that
2252  *	requested the scan is connected to (if available, otherwise this
2253  *	attribute must not be included).
2254  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_START_TIME_TSF_BSSID: The BSS according to which
2255  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_START_TIME_TSF is set.
2256  * @NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION: measurement duration in TUs (u16). If
2257  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION_MANDATORY is not set, this is the
2258  *	maximum measurement duration allowed. This attribute is used with
2259  *	measurement requests. It can also be used with %NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN
2260  *	if the scan is used for beacon report radio measurement.
2261  * @NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION_MANDATORY: flag attribute that indicates
2262  *	that the duration specified with %NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION is
2263  *	mandatory. If this flag is not set, the duration is the maximum duration
2264  *	and the actual measurement duration may be shorter.
2265  *
2266  * @NL80211_ATTR_MESH_PEER_AID: Association ID for the mesh peer (u16). This is
2267  *	used to pull the stored data for mesh peer in power save state.
2268  *
2269  * @NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MASTER_PREF: the master preference to be used by
2270  *	%NL80211_CMD_START_NAN and optionally with
2271  *	%NL80211_CMD_CHANGE_NAN_CONFIG. Its type is u8 and it can't be 0.
2272  *	Also, values 1 and 255 are reserved for certification purposes and
2273  *	should not be used during a normal device operation.
2274  * @NL80211_ATTR_BANDS: operating bands configuration.  This is a u32
2275  *	bitmask of BIT(NL80211_BAND_*) as described in %enum
2276  *	nl80211_band.  For instance, for NL80211_BAND_2GHZ, bit 0
2277  *	would be set.  This attribute is used with
2278  *	%NL80211_CMD_START_NAN and %NL80211_CMD_CHANGE_NAN_CONFIG, and
2279  *	it is optional.  If no bands are set, it means don't-care and
2280  *	the device will decide what to use.
2281  * @NL80211_ATTR_NAN_FUNC: a function that can be added to NAN. See
2282  *	&enum nl80211_nan_func_attributes for description of this nested
2283  *	attribute.
2284  * @NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MATCH: used to report a match. This is a nested attribute.
2285  *	See &enum nl80211_nan_match_attributes.
2286  * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_KEK: KEK for FILS (Re)Association Request/Response frame
2287  *	protection.
2288  * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_NONCES: Nonces (part of AAD) for FILS (Re)Association
2289  *	Request/Response frame protection. This attribute contains the 16 octet
2290  *	STA Nonce followed by 16 octets of AP Nonce.
2291  *
2292  * @NL80211_ATTR_MULTICAST_TO_UNICAST_ENABLED: Indicates whether or not multicast
2293  *	packets should be send out as unicast to all stations (flag attribute).
2294  *
2295  * @NL80211_ATTR_BSSID: The BSSID of the AP. Note that %NL80211_ATTR_MAC is also
2296  *	used in various commands/events for specifying the BSSID.
2297  *
2298  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI: Relative RSSI threshold by which
2299  *	other BSSs has to be better or slightly worse than the current
2300  *	connected BSS so that they get reported to user space.
2301  *	This will give an opportunity to userspace to consider connecting to
2302  *	other matching BSSs which have better or slightly worse RSSI than
2303  *	the current connected BSS by using an offloaded operation to avoid
2304  *	unnecessary wakeups.
2305  *
2306  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RSSI_ADJUST: When present the RSSI level for BSSs in
2307  *	the specified band is to be adjusted before doing
2308  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI based comparison to figure out
2309  *	better BSSs. The attribute value is a packed structure
2310  *	value as specified by &struct nl80211_bss_select_rssi_adjust.
2311  *
2312  * @NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT_REASON: The reason for which an operation timed out.
2313  *	u32 attribute with an &enum nl80211_timeout_reason value. This is used,
2314  *	e.g., with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT event.
2315  *
2316  * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_USERNAME: EAP Re-authentication Protocol (ERP)
2317  *	username part of NAI used to refer keys rRK and rIK. This is used with
2318  *	%NL80211_CMD_CONNECT.
2319  *
2320  * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_REALM: EAP Re-authentication Protocol (ERP) realm part
2321  *	of NAI specifying the domain name of the ER server. This is used with
2322  *	%NL80211_CMD_CONNECT.
2323  *
2324  * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_NEXT_SEQ_NUM: Unsigned 16-bit ERP next sequence number
2325  *	to use in ERP messages. This is used in generating the FILS wrapped data
2326  *	for FILS authentication and is used with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT.
2327  *
2328  * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_RRK: ERP re-authentication Root Key (rRK) for the
2329  *	NAI specified by %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_USERNAME and
2330  *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_REALM. This is used for generating rIK and rMSK
2331  *	from successful FILS authentication and is used with
2332  *	%NL80211_CMD_CONNECT.
2333  *
2334  * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID: A 2-octet identifier advertized by a FILS AP
2335  *	identifying the scope of PMKSAs. This is used with
2336  *	@NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA and @NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMKSA.
2337  *
2338  * @NL80211_ATTR_PMK: attribute for passing PMK key material. Used with
2339  *	%NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA for the PMKSA identified by %NL80211_ATTR_PMKID.
2340  *	For %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT it is used to provide PSK for offloading 4-way
2341  *	handshake for WPA/WPA2-PSK networks. For 802.1X authentication it is
2342  *	used with %NL80211_CMD_SET_PMK. For offloaded FT support this attribute
2343  *	specifies the PMK-R0 if NL80211_ATTR_PMKR0_NAME is included as well.
2344  *
2345  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MULTI: flag attribute which user-space shall use to
2346  *	indicate that it supports multiple active scheduled scan requests.
2347  * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MAX_REQS: indicates maximum number of scheduled
2348  *	scan request that may be active for the device (u32).
2349  *
2350  * @NL80211_ATTR_WANT_1X_4WAY_HS: flag attribute which user-space can include
2351  *	in %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT to indicate that for 802.1X authentication it
2352  *	wants to use the supported offload of the 4-way handshake.
2353  * @NL80211_ATTR_PMKR0_NAME: PMK-R0 Name for offloaded FT.
2354  * @NL80211_ATTR_PORT_AUTHORIZED: (reserved)
2355  *
2356  * @NL80211_ATTR_EXTERNAL_AUTH_ACTION: Identify the requested external
2357  *     authentication operation (u32 attribute with an
2358  *     &enum nl80211_external_auth_action value). This is used with the
2359  *     %NL80211_CMD_EXTERNAL_AUTH request event.
2360  * @NL80211_ATTR_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT: Flag attribute indicating that the user
2361  *	space supports external authentication. This attribute shall be used
2362  *	with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT and %NL80211_CMD_START_AP request. The driver
2363  *	may offload authentication processing to user space if this capability
2364  *	is indicated in the respective requests from the user space.
2365  *
2366  * @NL80211_ATTR_NSS: Station's New/updated  RX_NSS value notified using this
2367  *	u8 attribute. This is used with %NL80211_CMD_STA_OPMODE_CHANGED.
2368  *
2369  * @NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_STATS: TXQ statistics (nested attribute, see &enum
2370  *      nl80211_txq_stats)
2371  * @NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_LIMIT: Total packet limit for the TXQ queues for this phy.
2372  *      The smaller of this and the memory limit is enforced.
2373  * @NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT: Total memory memory limit (in bytes) for the
2374  *      TXQ queues for this phy. The smaller of this and the packet limit is
2375  *      enforced.
2376  * @NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_QUANTUM: TXQ scheduler quantum (bytes). Number of bytes
2377  *      a flow is assigned on each round of the DRR scheduler.
2378  * @NL80211_ATTR_HE_CAPABILITY: HE Capability information element (from
2379  *	association request when used with NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION). Can be set
2380  *	only if %NL80211_STA_FLAG_WME is set.
2381  *
2382  * @NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER: nested attribute which user-space can include
2383  *	in %NL80211_CMD_START_AP or %NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON for fine timing
2384  *	measurement (FTM) responder functionality and containing parameters as
2385  *	possible, see &enum nl80211_ftm_responder_attr
2386  *
2387  * @NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS: Nested attribute with FTM responder
2388  *	statistics, see &enum nl80211_ftm_responder_stats.
2389  *
2390  * @NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT: Timeout for the given operation in milliseconds (u32),
2391  *	if the attribute is not given no timeout is requested. Note that 0 is an
2392  *	invalid value.
2393  *
2394  * @NL80211_ATTR_PEER_MEASUREMENTS: peer measurements request (and result)
2395  *	data, uses nested attributes specified in
2396  *	&enum nl80211_peer_measurement_attrs.
2397  *	This is also used for capability advertisement in the wiphy information,
2398  *	with the appropriate sub-attributes.
2399  *
2400  * @NL80211_ATTR_AIRTIME_WEIGHT: Station's weight when scheduled by the airtime
2401  *	scheduler.
2402  *
2403  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_TX_POWER_SETTING: Transmit power setting type (u8) for
2404  *	station associated with the AP. See &enum nl80211_tx_power_setting for
2405  *	possible values.
2406  * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_TX_POWER: Transmit power level (s16) in dBm units. This
2407  *	allows to set Tx power for a station. If this attribute is not included,
2408  *	the default per-interface tx power setting will be overriding. Driver
2409  *	should be picking up the lowest tx power, either tx power per-interface
2410  *	or per-station.
2411  *
2412  * @NL80211_ATTR_SAE_PASSWORD: attribute for passing SAE password material. It
2413  *	is used with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT to provide password for offloading
2414  *	SAE authentication for WPA3-Personal networks.
2415  *
2416  * @NL80211_ATTR_TWT_RESPONDER: Enable target wait time responder support.
2417  *
2418  * @NL80211_ATTR_HE_OBSS_PD: nested attribute for OBSS Packet Detection
2419  *	functionality.
2420  *
2421  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_EDMG_CHANNELS: bitmap that indicates the 2.16 GHz
2422  *	channel(s) that are allowed to be used for EDMG transmissions.
2423  *	Defined by IEEE P802.11ay/D4.0 section 9.4.2.251. (u8 attribute)
2424  * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_EDMG_BW_CONFIG: Channel BW Configuration subfield encodes
2425  *	the allowed channel bandwidth configurations. (u8 attribute)
2426  *	Defined by IEEE P802.11ay/D4.0 section 9.4.2.251, Table 13.
2427  *
2428  * @NL80211_ATTR_VLAN_ID: VLAN ID (1..4094) for the station and VLAN group key
2429  *	(u16).
2430  *
2431  * @NL80211_ATTR_HE_BSS_COLOR: nested attribute for BSS Color Settings.
2432  *
2433  * @NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE_AKM_SUITES: nested array attribute, with each entry
2434  *	using attributes from &enum nl80211_iftype_akm_attributes. This
2435  *	attribute is sent in a response to %NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY indicating
2436  *	supported AKM suites capability per interface. AKMs advertised in
2437  *	%NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES are default capabilities if AKM suites not
2438  *	advertised for a specific interface type.
2439  *
2440  * @NL80211_ATTR_TID_CONFIG: TID specific configuration in a
2441  *	nested attribute with &enum nl80211_tid_config_attr sub-attributes;
2442  *	on output (in wiphy attributes) it contains only the feature sub-
2443  *	attributes.
2444  *
2445  * @NUM_NL80211_ATTR: total number of nl80211_attrs available
2446  * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number currently defined
2447  * @__NL80211_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
2448  */
2449 enum nl80211_attrs {
2450 /* don't change the order or add anything between, this is ABI! */
2451 	NL80211_ATTR_UNSPEC,
2452 
2453 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY,
2454 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_NAME,
2455 
2456 	NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX,
2457 	NL80211_ATTR_IFNAME,
2458 	NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE,
2459 
2460 	NL80211_ATTR_MAC,
2461 
2462 	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DATA,
2463 	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX,
2464 	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_CIPHER,
2465 	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_SEQ,
2466 	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT,
2467 
2468 	NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_INTERVAL,
2469 	NL80211_ATTR_DTIM_PERIOD,
2470 	NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_HEAD,
2471 	NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_TAIL,
2472 
2473 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_AID,
2474 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_FLAGS,
2475 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_LISTEN_INTERVAL,
2476 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_RATES,
2477 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_VLAN,
2478 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_INFO,
2479 
2480 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_BANDS,
2481 
2482 	NL80211_ATTR_MNTR_FLAGS,
2483 
2484 	NL80211_ATTR_MESH_ID,
2485 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_PLINK_ACTION,
2486 	NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_NEXT_HOP,
2487 	NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_INFO,
2488 
2489 	NL80211_ATTR_BSS_CTS_PROT,
2490 	NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SHORT_PREAMBLE,
2491 	NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME,
2492 
2493 	NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY,
2494 
2495 	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_IFTYPES,
2496 
2497 	NL80211_ATTR_REG_ALPHA2,
2498 	NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULES,
2499 
2500 	NL80211_ATTR_MESH_CONFIG,
2501 
2502 	NL80211_ATTR_BSS_BASIC_RATES,
2503 
2504 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TXQ_PARAMS,
2505 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ,
2506 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_CHANNEL_TYPE,
2507 
2508 	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT_MGMT,
2509 
2510 	NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE,
2511 	NL80211_ATTR_IE,
2512 
2513 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCAN_SSIDS,
2514 
2515 	NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES,
2516 	NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SSIDS,
2517 	NL80211_ATTR_GENERATION, /* replaces old SCAN_GENERATION */
2518 	NL80211_ATTR_BSS,
2519 
2520 	NL80211_ATTR_REG_INITIATOR,
2521 	NL80211_ATTR_REG_TYPE,
2522 
2523 	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_COMMANDS,
2524 
2525 	NL80211_ATTR_FRAME,
2526 	NL80211_ATTR_SSID,
2527 	NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE,
2528 	NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE,
2529 
2530 	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_TYPE,
2531 
2532 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_IE_LEN,
2533 	NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES,
2534 
2535 	NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_BEFORE,
2536 	NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_AFTER,
2537 
2538 	NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_FIXED,
2539 
2540 
2541 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_SHORT,
2542 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_LONG,
2543 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FRAG_THRESHOLD,
2544 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RTS_THRESHOLD,
2545 
2546 	NL80211_ATTR_TIMED_OUT,
2547 
2548 	NL80211_ATTR_USE_MFP,
2549 
2550 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_FLAGS2,
2551 
2552 	NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT,
2553 
2554 	NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA,
2555 
2556 	NL80211_ATTR_PRIVACY,
2557 
2558 	NL80211_ATTR_DISCONNECTED_BY_AP,
2559 	NL80211_ATTR_STATUS_CODE,
2560 
2561 	NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES_PAIRWISE,
2562 	NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITE_GROUP,
2563 	NL80211_ATTR_WPA_VERSIONS,
2564 	NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES,
2565 
2566 	NL80211_ATTR_REQ_IE,
2567 	NL80211_ATTR_RESP_IE,
2568 
2569 	NL80211_ATTR_PREV_BSSID,
2570 
2571 	NL80211_ATTR_KEY,
2572 	NL80211_ATTR_KEYS,
2573 
2574 	NL80211_ATTR_PID,
2575 
2576 	NL80211_ATTR_4ADDR,
2577 
2578 	NL80211_ATTR_SURVEY_INFO,
2579 
2580 	NL80211_ATTR_PMKID,
2581 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_PMKIDS,
2582 
2583 	NL80211_ATTR_DURATION,
2584 
2585 	NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE,
2586 
2587 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_COVERAGE_CLASS,
2588 
2589 	NL80211_ATTR_TX_RATES,
2590 
2591 	NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_MATCH,
2592 
2593 	NL80211_ATTR_ACK,
2594 
2595 	NL80211_ATTR_PS_STATE,
2596 
2597 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM,
2598 
2599 	NL80211_ATTR_LOCAL_STATE_CHANGE,
2600 
2601 	NL80211_ATTR_AP_ISOLATE,
2602 
2603 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TX_POWER_SETTING,
2604 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TX_POWER_LEVEL,
2605 
2606 	NL80211_ATTR_TX_FRAME_TYPES,
2607 	NL80211_ATTR_RX_FRAME_TYPES,
2608 	NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_TYPE,
2609 
2610 	NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE,
2611 	NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_ENCRYPT,
2612 
2613 	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_IBSS_RSN,
2614 
2615 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX,
2616 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_RX,
2617 
2618 	NL80211_ATTR_MCAST_RATE,
2619 
2620 	NL80211_ATTR_OFFCHANNEL_TX_OK,
2621 
2622 	NL80211_ATTR_BSS_HT_OPMODE,
2623 
2624 	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES,
2625 
2626 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL_DURATION,
2627 
2628 	NL80211_ATTR_MESH_SETUP,
2629 
2630 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_AVAIL_TX,
2631 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_AVAIL_RX,
2632 
2633 	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_MESH_AUTH,
2634 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_PLINK_STATE,
2635 
2636 	NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS,
2637 	NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS_SUPPORTED,
2638 
2639 	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_INTERVAL,
2640 
2641 	NL80211_ATTR_INTERFACE_COMBINATIONS,
2642 	NL80211_ATTR_SOFTWARE_IFTYPES,
2643 
2644 	NL80211_ATTR_REKEY_DATA,
2645 
2646 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCHED_SCAN_SSIDS,
2647 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCHED_SCAN_IE_LEN,
2648 
2649 	NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SUPP_RATES,
2650 
2651 	NL80211_ATTR_HIDDEN_SSID,
2652 
2653 	NL80211_ATTR_IE_PROBE_RESP,
2654 	NL80211_ATTR_IE_ASSOC_RESP,
2655 
2656 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_WME,
2657 	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_AP_UAPSD,
2658 
2659 	NL80211_ATTR_ROAM_SUPPORT,
2660 
2661 	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH,
2662 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_MATCH_SETS,
2663 
2664 	NL80211_ATTR_PMKSA_CANDIDATE,
2665 
2666 	NL80211_ATTR_TX_NO_CCK_RATE,
2667 
2668 	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_ACTION,
2669 	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_DIALOG_TOKEN,
2670 	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_OPERATION,
2671 	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_SUPPORT,
2672 	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP,
2673 
2674 	NL80211_ATTR_DEVICE_AP_SME,
2675 
2676 	NL80211_ATTR_DONT_WAIT_FOR_ACK,
2677 
2678 	NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS,
2679 
2680 	NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD,
2681 
2682 	NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP,
2683 
2684 	NL80211_ATTR_DFS_REGION,
2685 
2686 	NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_HT,
2687 	NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY_MASK,
2688 
2689 	NL80211_ATTR_NOACK_MAP,
2690 
2691 	NL80211_ATTR_INACTIVITY_TIMEOUT,
2692 
2693 	NL80211_ATTR_RX_SIGNAL_DBM,
2694 
2695 	NL80211_ATTR_BG_SCAN_PERIOD,
2696 
2697 	NL80211_ATTR_WDEV,
2698 
2699 	NL80211_ATTR_USER_REG_HINT_TYPE,
2700 
2701 	NL80211_ATTR_CONN_FAILED_REASON,
2702 
2703 	NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_DATA,
2704 
2705 	NL80211_ATTR_VHT_CAPABILITY,
2706 
2707 	NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FLAGS,
2708 
2709 	NL80211_ATTR_CHANNEL_WIDTH,
2710 	NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1,
2711 	NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ2,
2712 
2713 	NL80211_ATTR_P2P_CTWINDOW,
2714 	NL80211_ATTR_P2P_OPPPS,
2715 
2716 	NL80211_ATTR_LOCAL_MESH_POWER_MODE,
2717 
2718 	NL80211_ATTR_ACL_POLICY,
2719 
2720 	NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ADDRS,
2721 
2722 	NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ACL_MAX,
2723 
2724 	NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_EVENT,
2725 
2726 	NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA,
2727 	NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA_MASK,
2728 
2729 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_CAPABILITY,
2730 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_EXT_CAPABILITY,
2731 
2732 	NL80211_ATTR_PROTOCOL_FEATURES,
2733 	NL80211_ATTR_SPLIT_WIPHY_DUMP,
2734 
2735 	NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_VHT,
2736 	NL80211_ATTR_VHT_CAPABILITY_MASK,
2737 
2738 	NL80211_ATTR_MDID,
2739 	NL80211_ATTR_IE_RIC,
2740 
2741 	NL80211_ATTR_CRIT_PROT_ID,
2742 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_CRIT_PROT_DURATION,
2743 
2744 	NL80211_ATTR_PEER_AID,
2745 
2746 	NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE,
2747 
2748 	NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_COUNT,
2749 	NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_BLOCK_TX,
2750 	NL80211_ATTR_CSA_IES,
2751 	NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFF_BEACON,
2752 	NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFF_PRESP,
2753 
2754 	NL80211_ATTR_RXMGMT_FLAGS,
2755 
2756 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_CHANNELS,
2757 
2758 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_OPER_CLASSES,
2759 
2760 	NL80211_ATTR_HANDLE_DFS,
2761 
2762 	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_5_MHZ,
2763 	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_10_MHZ,
2764 
2765 	NL80211_ATTR_OPMODE_NOTIF,
2766 
2767 	NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_ID,
2768 	NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_SUBCMD,
2769 	NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA,
2770 	NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_EVENTS,
2771 
2772 	NL80211_ATTR_QOS_MAP,
2773 
2774 	NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT,
2775 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_HINT,
2776 
2777 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_AP_ASSOC_STA,
2778 
2779 	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_PEER_CAPABILITY,
2780 
2781 	NL80211_ATTR_SOCKET_OWNER,
2782 
2783 	NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFFSETS_TX,
2784 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_CSA_COUNTERS,
2785 
2786 	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_INITIATOR,
2787 
2788 	NL80211_ATTR_USE_RRM,
2789 
2790 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_DYN_ACK,
2791 
2792 	NL80211_ATTR_TSID,
2793 	NL80211_ATTR_USER_PRIO,
2794 	NL80211_ATTR_ADMITTED_TIME,
2795 
2796 	NL80211_ATTR_SMPS_MODE,
2797 
2798 	NL80211_ATTR_OPER_CLASS,
2799 
2800 	NL80211_ATTR_MAC_MASK,
2801 
2802 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_SELF_MANAGED_REG,
2803 
2804 	NL80211_ATTR_EXT_FEATURES,
2805 
2806 	NL80211_ATTR_SURVEY_RADIO_STATS,
2807 
2808 	NL80211_ATTR_NETNS_FD,
2809 
2810 	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_DELAY,
2811 
2812 	NL80211_ATTR_REG_INDOOR,
2813 
2814 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS,
2815 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_PLAN_INTERVAL,
2816 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_PLAN_ITERATIONS,
2817 	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS,
2818 
2819 	NL80211_ATTR_PBSS,
2820 
2821 	NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SELECT,
2822 
2823 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORT_P2P_PS,
2824 
2825 	NL80211_ATTR_PAD,
2826 
2827 	NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE_EXT_CAPA,
2828 
2829 	NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_GROUP_DATA,
2830 	NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_FOLLOW_MAC_ADDR,
2831 
2832 	NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_START_TIME_TSF,
2833 	NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_START_TIME_TSF_BSSID,
2834 	NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION,
2835 	NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION_MANDATORY,
2836 
2837 	NL80211_ATTR_MESH_PEER_AID,
2838 
2839 	NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MASTER_PREF,
2840 	NL80211_ATTR_BANDS,
2841 	NL80211_ATTR_NAN_FUNC,
2842 	NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MATCH,
2843 
2844 	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_KEK,
2845 	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_NONCES,
2846 
2847 	NL80211_ATTR_MULTICAST_TO_UNICAST_ENABLED,
2848 
2849 	NL80211_ATTR_BSSID,
2850 
2851 	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI,
2852 	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RSSI_ADJUST,
2853 
2854 	NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT_REASON,
2855 
2856 	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_USERNAME,
2857 	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_REALM,
2858 	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_NEXT_SEQ_NUM,
2859 	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_RRK,
2860 	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID,
2861 
2862 	NL80211_ATTR_PMK,
2863 
2864 	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MULTI,
2865 	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MAX_REQS,
2866 
2867 	NL80211_ATTR_WANT_1X_4WAY_HS,
2868 	NL80211_ATTR_PMKR0_NAME,
2869 	NL80211_ATTR_PORT_AUTHORIZED,
2870 
2871 	NL80211_ATTR_EXTERNAL_AUTH_ACTION,
2872 	NL80211_ATTR_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT,
2873 
2874 	NL80211_ATTR_NSS,
2875 	NL80211_ATTR_ACK_SIGNAL,
2876 
2877 	NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211,
2878 
2879 	NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_STATS,
2880 	NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_LIMIT,
2881 	NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT,
2882 	NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_QUANTUM,
2883 
2884 	NL80211_ATTR_HE_CAPABILITY,
2885 
2886 	NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER,
2887 
2888 	NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS,
2889 
2890 	NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT,
2891 
2892 	NL80211_ATTR_PEER_MEASUREMENTS,
2893 
2894 	NL80211_ATTR_AIRTIME_WEIGHT,
2895 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_TX_POWER_SETTING,
2896 	NL80211_ATTR_STA_TX_POWER,
2897 
2898 	NL80211_ATTR_SAE_PASSWORD,
2899 
2900 	NL80211_ATTR_TWT_RESPONDER,
2901 
2902 	NL80211_ATTR_HE_OBSS_PD,
2903 
2904 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_EDMG_CHANNELS,
2905 	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_EDMG_BW_CONFIG,
2906 
2907 	NL80211_ATTR_VLAN_ID,
2908 
2909 	NL80211_ATTR_HE_BSS_COLOR,
2910 
2911 	NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE_AKM_SUITES,
2912 
2913 	NL80211_ATTR_TID_CONFIG,
2914 
2915 	/* add attributes here, update the policy in nl80211.c */
2916 
2917 	__NL80211_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
2918 	NUM_NL80211_ATTR = __NL80211_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
2919 	NL80211_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
2920 };
2921 
2922 /* source-level API compatibility */
2923 #define NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_GENERATION NL80211_ATTR_GENERATION
2924 #define	NL80211_ATTR_MESH_PARAMS NL80211_ATTR_MESH_CONFIG
2925 #define NL80211_ATTR_IFACE_SOCKET_OWNER NL80211_ATTR_SOCKET_OWNER
2926 #define NL80211_ATTR_SAE_DATA NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_DATA
2927 
2928 /*
2929  * Allow user space programs to use #ifdef on new attributes by defining them
2930  * here
2931  */
2932 #define NL80211_CMD_CONNECT NL80211_CMD_CONNECT
2933 #define NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY
2934 #define NL80211_ATTR_BSS_BASIC_RATES NL80211_ATTR_BSS_BASIC_RATES
2935 #define NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TXQ_PARAMS NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TXQ_PARAMS
2936 #define NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ
2937 #define NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_CHANNEL_TYPE NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_CHANNEL_TYPE
2938 #define NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE
2939 #define NL80211_ATTR_IE NL80211_ATTR_IE
2940 #define NL80211_ATTR_REG_INITIATOR NL80211_ATTR_REG_INITIATOR
2941 #define NL80211_ATTR_REG_TYPE NL80211_ATTR_REG_TYPE
2942 #define NL80211_ATTR_FRAME NL80211_ATTR_FRAME
2943 #define NL80211_ATTR_SSID NL80211_ATTR_SSID
2944 #define NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE
2945 #define NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE
2946 #define NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES_PAIRWISE NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES_PAIRWISE
2947 #define NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITE_GROUP NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITE_GROUP
2948 #define NL80211_ATTR_WPA_VERSIONS NL80211_ATTR_WPA_VERSIONS
2949 #define NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES
2950 #define NL80211_ATTR_KEY NL80211_ATTR_KEY
2951 #define NL80211_ATTR_KEYS NL80211_ATTR_KEYS
2952 #define NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS
2953 
2954 #define NL80211_WIPHY_NAME_MAXLEN		64
2955 
2956 #define NL80211_MAX_SUPP_RATES			32
2957 #define NL80211_MAX_SUPP_HT_RATES		77
2958 #define NL80211_MAX_SUPP_REG_RULES		128
2959 #define NL80211_TKIP_DATA_OFFSET_ENCR_KEY	0
2960 #define NL80211_TKIP_DATA_OFFSET_TX_MIC_KEY	16
2961 #define NL80211_TKIP_DATA_OFFSET_RX_MIC_KEY	24
2962 #define NL80211_HT_CAPABILITY_LEN		26
2963 #define NL80211_VHT_CAPABILITY_LEN		12
2964 #define NL80211_HE_MIN_CAPABILITY_LEN           16
2965 #define NL80211_HE_MAX_CAPABILITY_LEN           54
2966 #define NL80211_MAX_NR_CIPHER_SUITES		5
2967 #define NL80211_MAX_NR_AKM_SUITES		2
2968 
2969 #define NL80211_MIN_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL_TIME	10
2970 
2971 /* default RSSI threshold for scan results if none specified. */
2972 #define NL80211_SCAN_RSSI_THOLD_OFF		-300
2973 
2974 #define NL80211_CQM_TXE_MAX_INTVL		1800
2975 
2976 /**
2977  * enum nl80211_iftype - (virtual) interface types
2978  *
2979  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_UNSPECIFIED: unspecified type, driver decides
2980  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_ADHOC: independent BSS member
2981  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION: managed BSS member
2982  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_AP: access point
2983  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_AP_VLAN: VLAN interface for access points; VLAN interfaces
2984  *	are a bit special in that they must always be tied to a pre-existing
2985  *	AP type interface.
2986  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_WDS: wireless distribution interface
2987  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_MONITOR: monitor interface receiving all frames
2988  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_MESH_POINT: mesh point
2989  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT: P2P client
2990  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO: P2P group owner
2991  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_DEVICE: P2P device interface type, this is not a netdev
2992  *	and therefore can't be created in the normal ways, use the
2993  *	%NL80211_CMD_START_P2P_DEVICE and %NL80211_CMD_STOP_P2P_DEVICE
2994  *	commands to create and destroy one
2995  * @NL80211_IF_TYPE_OCB: Outside Context of a BSS
2996  *	This mode corresponds to the MIB variable dot11OCBActivated=true
2997  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_NAN: NAN device interface type (not a netdev)
2998  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_MAX: highest interface type number currently defined
2999  * @NUM_NL80211_IFTYPES: number of defined interface types
3000  *
3001  * These values are used with the %NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE
3002  * to set the type of an interface.
3003  *
3004  */
3005 enum nl80211_iftype {
3006 	NL80211_IFTYPE_UNSPECIFIED,
3007 	NL80211_IFTYPE_ADHOC,
3008 	NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION,
3009 	NL80211_IFTYPE_AP,
3010 	NL80211_IFTYPE_AP_VLAN,
3011 	NL80211_IFTYPE_WDS,
3012 	NL80211_IFTYPE_MONITOR,
3013 	NL80211_IFTYPE_MESH_POINT,
3014 	NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT,
3015 	NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO,
3016 	NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_DEVICE,
3017 	NL80211_IFTYPE_OCB,
3018 	NL80211_IFTYPE_NAN,
3019 
3020 	/* keep last */
3021 	NUM_NL80211_IFTYPES,
3022 	NL80211_IFTYPE_MAX = NUM_NL80211_IFTYPES - 1
3023 };
3024 
3025 /**
3026  * enum nl80211_sta_flags - station flags
3027  *
3028  * Station flags. When a station is added to an AP interface, it is
3029  * assumed to be already associated (and hence authenticated.)
3030  *
3031  * @__NL80211_STA_FLAG_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3032  * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED: station is authorized (802.1X)
3033  * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_SHORT_PREAMBLE: station is capable of receiving frames
3034  *	with short barker preamble
3035  * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_WME: station is WME/QoS capable
3036  * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_MFP: station uses management frame protection
3037  * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHENTICATED: station is authenticated
3038  * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_TDLS_PEER: station is a TDLS peer -- this flag should
3039  *	only be used in managed mode (even in the flags mask). Note that the
3040  *	flag can't be changed, it is only valid while adding a station, and
3041  *	attempts to change it will silently be ignored (rather than rejected
3042  *	as errors.)
3043  * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_ASSOCIATED: station is associated; used with drivers
3044  *	that support %NL80211_FEATURE_FULL_AP_CLIENT_STATE to transition a
3045  *	previously added station into associated state
3046  * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_MAX: highest station flag number currently defined
3047  * @__NL80211_STA_FLAG_AFTER_LAST: internal use
3048  */
3049 enum nl80211_sta_flags {
3050 	__NL80211_STA_FLAG_INVALID,
3051 	NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED,
3052 	NL80211_STA_FLAG_SHORT_PREAMBLE,
3053 	NL80211_STA_FLAG_WME,
3054 	NL80211_STA_FLAG_MFP,
3055 	NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHENTICATED,
3056 	NL80211_STA_FLAG_TDLS_PEER,
3057 	NL80211_STA_FLAG_ASSOCIATED,
3058 
3059 	/* keep last */
3060 	__NL80211_STA_FLAG_AFTER_LAST,
3061 	NL80211_STA_FLAG_MAX = __NL80211_STA_FLAG_AFTER_LAST - 1
3062 };
3063 
3064 /**
3065  * enum nl80211_sta_p2p_ps_status - station support of P2P PS
3066  *
3067  * @NL80211_P2P_PS_UNSUPPORTED: station doesn't support P2P PS mechanism
3068  * @@NL80211_P2P_PS_SUPPORTED: station supports P2P PS mechanism
3069  * @NUM_NL80211_P2P_PS_STATUS: number of values
3070  */
3071 enum nl80211_sta_p2p_ps_status {
3072 	NL80211_P2P_PS_UNSUPPORTED = 0,
3073 	NL80211_P2P_PS_SUPPORTED,
3074 
3075 	NUM_NL80211_P2P_PS_STATUS,
3076 };
3077 
3078 #define NL80211_STA_FLAG_MAX_OLD_API	NL80211_STA_FLAG_TDLS_PEER
3079 
3080 /**
3081  * struct nl80211_sta_flag_update - station flags mask/set
3082  * @mask: mask of station flags to set
3083  * @set: which values to set them to
3084  *
3085  * Both mask and set contain bits as per &enum nl80211_sta_flags.
3086  */
3087 struct nl80211_sta_flag_update {
3088 	__u32 mask;
3089 	__u32 set;
3090 } __attribute__((packed));
3091 
3092 /**
3093  * enum nl80211_he_gi - HE guard interval
3094  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_0_8: 0.8 usec
3095  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_1_6: 1.6 usec
3096  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_3_2: 3.2 usec
3097  */
3098 enum nl80211_he_gi {
3099 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_0_8,
3100 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_1_6,
3101 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_3_2,
3102 };
3103 
3104 /**
3105  * enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc - HE RU allocation values
3106  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_26: 26-tone RU allocation
3107  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_52: 52-tone RU allocation
3108  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_106: 106-tone RU allocation
3109  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_242: 242-tone RU allocation
3110  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_484: 484-tone RU allocation
3111  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_996: 996-tone RU allocation
3112  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_2x996: 2x996-tone RU allocation
3113  */
3114 enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc {
3115 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_26,
3116 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_52,
3117 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_106,
3118 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_242,
3119 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_484,
3120 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_996,
3121 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_2x996,
3122 };
3123 
3124 /**
3125  * enum nl80211_rate_info - bitrate information
3126  *
3127  * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_STA_INFO_TXRATE
3128  * when getting information about the bitrate of a station.
3129  * There are 2 attributes for bitrate, a legacy one that represents
3130  * a 16-bit value, and new one that represents a 32-bit value.
3131  * If the rate value fits into 16 bit, both attributes are reported
3132  * with the same value. If the rate is too high to fit into 16 bits
3133  * (>6.5535Gbps) only 32-bit attribute is included.
3134  * User space tools encouraged to use the 32-bit attribute and fall
3135  * back to the 16-bit one for compatibility with older kernels.
3136  *
3137  * @__NL80211_RATE_INFO_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3138  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_BITRATE: total bitrate (u16, 100kbit/s)
3139  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_MCS: mcs index for 802.11n (u8)
3140  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_40_MHZ_WIDTH: 40 MHz dualchannel bitrate
3141  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_SHORT_GI: 400ns guard interval
3142  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_BITRATE32: total bitrate (u32, 100kbit/s)
3143  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_MAX: highest rate_info number currently defined
3144  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_VHT_MCS: MCS index for VHT (u8)
3145  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_VHT_NSS: number of streams in VHT (u8)
3146  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_80_MHZ_WIDTH: 80 MHz VHT rate
3147  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_80P80_MHZ_WIDTH: unused - 80+80 is treated the
3148  *	same as 160 for purposes of the bitrates
3149  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_160_MHZ_WIDTH: 160 MHz VHT rate
3150  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_10_MHZ_WIDTH: 10 MHz width - note that this is
3151  *	a legacy rate and will be reported as the actual bitrate, i.e.
3152  *	half the base (20 MHz) rate
3153  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_5_MHZ_WIDTH: 5 MHz width - note that this is
3154  *	a legacy rate and will be reported as the actual bitrate, i.e.
3155  *	a quarter of the base (20 MHz) rate
3156  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_MCS: HE MCS index (u8, 0-11)
3157  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_NSS: HE NSS value (u8, 1-8)
3158  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI: HE guard interval identifier
3159  *	(u8, see &enum nl80211_he_gi)
3160  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_DCM: HE DCM value (u8, 0/1)
3161  * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_RU_ALLOC: HE RU allocation, if not present then
3162  *	non-OFDMA was used (u8, see &enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc)
3163  * @__NL80211_RATE_INFO_AFTER_LAST: internal use
3164  */
3165 enum nl80211_rate_info {
3166 	__NL80211_RATE_INFO_INVALID,
3167 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_BITRATE,
3168 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_MCS,
3169 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_40_MHZ_WIDTH,
3170 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_SHORT_GI,
3171 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_BITRATE32,
3172 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_VHT_MCS,
3173 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_VHT_NSS,
3174 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_80_MHZ_WIDTH,
3175 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_80P80_MHZ_WIDTH,
3176 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_160_MHZ_WIDTH,
3177 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_10_MHZ_WIDTH,
3178 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_5_MHZ_WIDTH,
3179 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_MCS,
3180 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_NSS,
3181 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI,
3182 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_DCM,
3183 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC,
3184 
3185 	/* keep last */
3186 	__NL80211_RATE_INFO_AFTER_LAST,
3187 	NL80211_RATE_INFO_MAX = __NL80211_RATE_INFO_AFTER_LAST - 1
3188 };
3189 
3190 /**
3191  * enum nl80211_sta_bss_param - BSS information collected by STA
3192  *
3193  * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_STA_INFO_BSS_PARAM
3194  * when getting information about the bitrate of a station.
3195  *
3196  * @__NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3197  * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_CTS_PROT: whether CTS protection is enabled (flag)
3198  * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_SHORT_PREAMBLE:  whether short preamble is enabled
3199  *	(flag)
3200  * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_SHORT_SLOT_TIME:  whether short slot time is enabled
3201  *	(flag)
3202  * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_DTIM_PERIOD: DTIM period for beaconing (u8)
3203  * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_BEACON_INTERVAL: Beacon interval (u16)
3204  * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_MAX: highest sta_bss_param number currently defined
3205  * @__NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_AFTER_LAST: internal use
3206  */
3207 enum nl80211_sta_bss_param {
3208 	__NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_INVALID,
3209 	NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_CTS_PROT,
3210 	NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_SHORT_PREAMBLE,
3211 	NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_SHORT_SLOT_TIME,
3212 	NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_DTIM_PERIOD,
3213 	NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_BEACON_INTERVAL,
3214 
3215 	/* keep last */
3216 	__NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_AFTER_LAST,
3217 	NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_MAX = __NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_AFTER_LAST - 1
3218 };
3219 
3220 /**
3221  * enum nl80211_sta_info - station information
3222  *
3223  * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_ATTR_STA_INFO
3224  * when getting information about a station.
3225  *
3226  * @__NL80211_STA_INFO_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3227  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_INACTIVE_TIME: time since last activity (u32, msecs)
3228  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BYTES: total received bytes (MPDU length)
3229  *	(u32, from this station)
3230  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BYTES: total transmitted bytes (MPDU length)
3231  *	(u32, to this station)
3232  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BYTES64: total received bytes (MPDU length)
3233  *	(u64, from this station)
3234  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BYTES64: total transmitted bytes (MPDU length)
3235  *	(u64, to this station)
3236  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_SIGNAL: signal strength of last received PPDU (u8, dBm)
3237  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BITRATE: current unicast tx rate, nested attribute
3238  * 	containing info as possible, see &enum nl80211_rate_info
3239  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_PACKETS: total received packet (MSDUs and MMPDUs)
3240  *	(u32, from this station)
3241  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_PACKETS: total transmitted packets (MSDUs and MMPDUs)
3242  *	(u32, to this station)
3243  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_RETRIES: total retries (MPDUs) (u32, to this station)
3244  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_FAILED: total failed packets (MPDUs)
3245  *	(u32, to this station)
3246  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_SIGNAL_AVG: signal strength average (u8, dBm)
3247  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_LLID: the station's mesh LLID
3248  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_PLID: the station's mesh PLID
3249  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_PLINK_STATE: peer link state for the station
3250  *	(see %enum nl80211_plink_state)
3251  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BITRATE: last unicast data frame rx rate, nested
3252  *	attribute, like NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BITRATE.
3253  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_BSS_PARAM: current station's view of BSS, nested attribute
3254  *     containing info as possible, see &enum nl80211_sta_bss_param
3255  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TIME: time since the station is last connected
3256  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_STA_FLAGS: Contains a struct nl80211_sta_flag_update.
3257  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_LOSS: count of times beacon loss was detected (u32)
3258  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_T_OFFSET: timing offset with respect to this STA (s64)
3259  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_LOCAL_PM: local mesh STA link-specific power mode
3260  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_PEER_PM: peer mesh STA link-specific power mode
3261  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_NONPEER_PM: neighbor mesh STA power save mode towards
3262  *	non-peer STA
3263  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_CHAIN_SIGNAL: per-chain signal strength of last PPDU
3264  *	Contains a nested array of signal strength attributes (u8, dBm)
3265  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_CHAIN_SIGNAL_AVG: per-chain signal strength average
3266  *	Same format as NL80211_STA_INFO_CHAIN_SIGNAL.
3267  * @NL80211_STA_EXPECTED_THROUGHPUT: expected throughput considering also the
3268  *	802.11 header (u32, kbps)
3269  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_DROP_MISC: RX packets dropped for unspecified reasons
3270  *	(u64)
3271  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_RX: number of beacons received from this peer (u64)
3272  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_SIGNAL_AVG: signal strength average
3273  *	for beacons only (u8, dBm)
3274  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TID_STATS: per-TID statistics (see &enum nl80211_tid_stats)
3275  *	This is a nested attribute where each the inner attribute number is the
3276  *	TID+1 and the special TID 16 (i.e. value 17) is used for non-QoS frames;
3277  *	each one of those is again nested with &enum nl80211_tid_stats
3278  *	attributes carrying the actual values.
3279  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_DURATION: aggregate PPDU duration for all frames
3280  *	received from the station (u64, usec)
3281  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_PAD: attribute used for padding for 64-bit alignment
3282  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_ACK_SIGNAL: signal strength of the last ACK frame(u8, dBm)
3283  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_ACK_SIGNAL_AVG: avg signal strength of ACK frames (s8, dBm)
3284  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_MPDUS: total number of received packets (MPDUs)
3285  *	(u32, from this station)
3286  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_FCS_ERROR_COUNT: total number of packets (MPDUs) received
3287  *	with an FCS error (u32, from this station). This count may not include
3288  *	some packets with an FCS error due to TA corruption. Hence this counter
3289  *	might not be fully accurate.
3290  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TO_GATE: set to true if STA has a path to a
3291  *	mesh gate (u8, 0 or 1)
3292  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_DURATION: aggregate PPDU duration for all frames
3293  *	sent to the station (u64, usec)
3294  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_AIRTIME_WEIGHT: current airtime weight for station (u16)
3295  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_AIRTIME_LINK_METRIC: airtime link metric for mesh station
3296  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_ASSOC_AT_BOOTTIME: Timestamp (CLOCK_BOOTTIME, nanoseconds)
3297  *	of STA's association
3298  * @__NL80211_STA_INFO_AFTER_LAST: internal
3299  * @NL80211_STA_INFO_MAX: highest possible station info attribute
3300  */
3301 enum nl80211_sta_info {
3302 	__NL80211_STA_INFO_INVALID,
3303 	NL80211_STA_INFO_INACTIVE_TIME,
3304 	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BYTES,
3305 	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BYTES,
3306 	NL80211_STA_INFO_LLID,
3307 	NL80211_STA_INFO_PLID,
3308 	NL80211_STA_INFO_PLINK_STATE,
3309 	NL80211_STA_INFO_SIGNAL,
3310 	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BITRATE,
3311 	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_PACKETS,
3312 	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_PACKETS,
3313 	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_RETRIES,
3314 	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_FAILED,
3315 	NL80211_STA_INFO_SIGNAL_AVG,
3316 	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BITRATE,
3317 	NL80211_STA_INFO_BSS_PARAM,
3318 	NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TIME,
3319 	NL80211_STA_INFO_STA_FLAGS,
3320 	NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_LOSS,
3321 	NL80211_STA_INFO_T_OFFSET,
3322 	NL80211_STA_INFO_LOCAL_PM,
3323 	NL80211_STA_INFO_PEER_PM,
3324 	NL80211_STA_INFO_NONPEER_PM,
3325 	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BYTES64,
3326 	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BYTES64,
3327 	NL80211_STA_INFO_CHAIN_SIGNAL,
3328 	NL80211_STA_INFO_CHAIN_SIGNAL_AVG,
3329 	NL80211_STA_INFO_EXPECTED_THROUGHPUT,
3330 	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_DROP_MISC,
3331 	NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_RX,
3332 	NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_SIGNAL_AVG,
3333 	NL80211_STA_INFO_TID_STATS,
3334 	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_DURATION,
3335 	NL80211_STA_INFO_PAD,
3336 	NL80211_STA_INFO_ACK_SIGNAL,
3337 	NL80211_STA_INFO_ACK_SIGNAL_AVG,
3338 	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_MPDUS,
3339 	NL80211_STA_INFO_FCS_ERROR_COUNT,
3340 	NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TO_GATE,
3341 	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_DURATION,
3342 	NL80211_STA_INFO_AIRTIME_WEIGHT,
3343 	NL80211_STA_INFO_AIRTIME_LINK_METRIC,
3344 	NL80211_STA_INFO_ASSOC_AT_BOOTTIME,
3345 
3346 	/* keep last */
3347 	__NL80211_STA_INFO_AFTER_LAST,
3348 	NL80211_STA_INFO_MAX = __NL80211_STA_INFO_AFTER_LAST - 1
3349 };
3350 
3351 /* we renamed this - stay compatible */
3352 #define NL80211_STA_INFO_DATA_ACK_SIGNAL_AVG NL80211_STA_INFO_ACK_SIGNAL_AVG
3353 
3354 
3355 /**
3356  * enum nl80211_tid_stats - per TID statistics attributes
3357  * @__NL80211_TID_STATS_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3358  * @NL80211_TID_STATS_RX_MSDU: number of MSDUs received (u64)
3359  * @NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU: number of MSDUs transmitted (or
3360  *	attempted to transmit; u64)
3361  * @NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU_RETRIES: number of retries for
3362  *	transmitted MSDUs (not counting the first attempt; u64)
3363  * @NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU_FAILED: number of failed transmitted
3364  *	MSDUs (u64)
3365  * @NL80211_TID_STATS_PAD: attribute used for padding for 64-bit alignment
3366  * @NL80211_TID_STATS_TXQ_STATS: TXQ stats (nested attribute)
3367  * @NUM_NL80211_TID_STATS: number of attributes here
3368  * @NL80211_TID_STATS_MAX: highest numbered attribute here
3369  */
3370 enum nl80211_tid_stats {
3371 	__NL80211_TID_STATS_INVALID,
3372 	NL80211_TID_STATS_RX_MSDU,
3373 	NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU,
3374 	NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU_RETRIES,
3375 	NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU_FAILED,
3376 	NL80211_TID_STATS_PAD,
3377 	NL80211_TID_STATS_TXQ_STATS,
3378 
3379 	/* keep last */
3380 	NUM_NL80211_TID_STATS,
3381 	NL80211_TID_STATS_MAX = NUM_NL80211_TID_STATS - 1
3382 };
3383 
3384 /**
3385  * enum nl80211_txq_stats - per TXQ statistics attributes
3386  * @__NL80211_TXQ_STATS_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3387  * @NUM_NL80211_TXQ_STATS: number of attributes here
3388  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_BACKLOG_BYTES: number of bytes currently backlogged
3389  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_BACKLOG_PACKETS: number of packets currently
3390  *      backlogged
3391  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_FLOWS: total number of new flows seen
3392  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_DROPS: total number of packet drops
3393  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_ECN_MARKS: total number of packet ECN marks
3394  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_OVERLIMIT: number of drops due to queue space overflow
3395  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_OVERMEMORY: number of drops due to memory limit overflow
3396  *      (only for per-phy stats)
3397  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_COLLISIONS: number of hash collisions
3398  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_TX_BYTES: total number of bytes dequeued from TXQ
3399  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_TX_PACKETS: total number of packets dequeued from TXQ
3400  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_MAX_FLOWS: number of flow buckets for PHY
3401  * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_MAX: highest numbered attribute here
3402  */
3403 enum nl80211_txq_stats {
3404 	__NL80211_TXQ_STATS_INVALID,
3405 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_BACKLOG_BYTES,
3406 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_BACKLOG_PACKETS,
3407 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_FLOWS,
3408 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_DROPS,
3409 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_ECN_MARKS,
3410 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_OVERLIMIT,
3411 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_OVERMEMORY,
3412 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_COLLISIONS,
3413 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_TX_BYTES,
3414 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_TX_PACKETS,
3415 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_MAX_FLOWS,
3416 
3417 	/* keep last */
3418 	NUM_NL80211_TXQ_STATS,
3419 	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_MAX = NUM_NL80211_TXQ_STATS - 1
3420 };
3421 
3422 /**
3423  * enum nl80211_mpath_flags - nl80211 mesh path flags
3424  *
3425  * @NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_ACTIVE: the mesh path is active
3426  * @NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_RESOLVING: the mesh path discovery process is running
3427  * @NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_SN_VALID: the mesh path contains a valid SN
3428  * @NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_FIXED: the mesh path has been manually set
3429  * @NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_RESOLVED: the mesh path discovery process succeeded
3430  */
3431 enum nl80211_mpath_flags {
3432 	NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_ACTIVE =	1<<0,
3433 	NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_RESOLVING =	1<<1,
3434 	NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_SN_VALID =	1<<2,
3435 	NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_FIXED =	1<<3,
3436 	NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_RESOLVED =	1<<4,
3437 };
3438 
3439 /**
3440  * enum nl80211_mpath_info - mesh path information
3441  *
3442  * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_INFO when getting
3443  * information about a mesh path.
3444  *
3445  * @__NL80211_MPATH_INFO_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3446  * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN: number of queued frames for this destination
3447  * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_SN: destination sequence number
3448  * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_METRIC: metric (cost) of this mesh path
3449  * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME: expiration time for the path, in msec from now
3450  * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_FLAGS: mesh path flags, enumerated in
3451  * 	&enum nl80211_mpath_flags;
3452  * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT: total path discovery timeout, in msec
3453  * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES: mesh path discovery retries
3454  * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT: hop count to destination
3455  * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE: total number of path changes to destination
3456  * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_MAX: highest mesh path information attribute number
3457  *	currently defined
3458  * @__NL80211_MPATH_INFO_AFTER_LAST: internal use
3459  */
3460 enum nl80211_mpath_info {
3461 	__NL80211_MPATH_INFO_INVALID,
3462 	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN,
3463 	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_SN,
3464 	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_METRIC,
3465 	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME,
3466 	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_FLAGS,
3467 	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT,
3468 	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES,
3469 	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT,
3470 	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE,
3471 
3472 	/* keep last */
3473 	__NL80211_MPATH_INFO_AFTER_LAST,
3474 	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_MAX = __NL80211_MPATH_INFO_AFTER_LAST - 1
3475 };
3476 
3477 /**
3478  * enum nl80211_band_iftype_attr - Interface type data attributes
3479  *
3480  * @__NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3481  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_IFTYPES: nested attribute containing a flag attribute
3482  *     for each interface type that supports the band data
3483  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_MAC: HE MAC capabilities as in HE
3484  *     capabilities IE
3485  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_PHY: HE PHY capabilities as in HE
3486  *     capabilities IE
3487  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_MCS_SET: HE supported NSS/MCS as in HE
3488  *     capabilities IE
3489  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_PPE: HE PPE thresholds information as
3490  *     defined in HE capabilities IE
3491  * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_MAX: highest band HE capability attribute currently
3492  *     defined
3493  * @__NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
3494  */
3495 enum nl80211_band_iftype_attr {
3496 	__NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_INVALID,
3497 
3498 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_IFTYPES,
3499 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_MAC,
3500 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_PHY,
3501 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_MCS_SET,
3502 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_PPE,
3503 
3504 	/* keep last */
3505 	__NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
3506 	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
3507 };
3508 
3509 /**
3510  * enum nl80211_band_attr - band attributes
3511  * @__NL80211_BAND_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3512  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_FREQS: supported frequencies in this band,
3513  *	an array of nested frequency attributes
3514  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_RATES: supported bitrates in this band,
3515  *	an array of nested bitrate attributes
3516  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_MCS_SET: 16-byte attribute containing the MCS set as
3517  *	defined in 802.11n
3518  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_CAPA: HT capabilities, as in the HT information IE
3519  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_AMPDU_FACTOR: A-MPDU factor, as in 11n
3520  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_AMPDU_DENSITY: A-MPDU density, as in 11n
3521  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_VHT_MCS_SET: 32-byte attribute containing the MCS set as
3522  *	defined in 802.11ac
3523  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_VHT_CAPA: VHT capabilities, as in the HT information IE
3524  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_IFTYPE_DATA: nested array attribute, with each entry using
3525  *	attributes from &enum nl80211_band_iftype_attr
3526  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_EDMG_CHANNELS: bitmap that indicates the 2.16 GHz
3527  *	channel(s) that are allowed to be used for EDMG transmissions.
3528  *	Defined by IEEE P802.11ay/D4.0 section 9.4.2.251.
3529  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_EDMG_BW_CONFIG: Channel BW Configuration subfield encodes
3530  *	the allowed channel bandwidth configurations.
3531  *	Defined by IEEE P802.11ay/D4.0 section 9.4.2.251, Table 13.
3532  * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_MAX: highest band attribute currently defined
3533  * @__NL80211_BAND_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
3534  */
3535 enum nl80211_band_attr {
3536 	__NL80211_BAND_ATTR_INVALID,
3537 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_FREQS,
3538 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_RATES,
3539 
3540 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_MCS_SET,
3541 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_CAPA,
3542 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_AMPDU_FACTOR,
3543 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_AMPDU_DENSITY,
3544 
3545 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_VHT_MCS_SET,
3546 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_VHT_CAPA,
3547 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_IFTYPE_DATA,
3548 
3549 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_EDMG_CHANNELS,
3550 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_EDMG_BW_CONFIG,
3551 
3552 	/* keep last */
3553 	__NL80211_BAND_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
3554 	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_BAND_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
3555 };
3556 
3557 #define NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_CAPA NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_CAPA
3558 
3559 /**
3560  * enum nl80211_wmm_rule - regulatory wmm rule
3561  *
3562  * @__NL80211_WMMR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3563  * @NL80211_WMMR_CW_MIN: Minimum contention window slot.
3564  * @NL80211_WMMR_CW_MAX: Maximum contention window slot.
3565  * @NL80211_WMMR_AIFSN: Arbitration Inter Frame Space.
3566  * @NL80211_WMMR_TXOP: Maximum allowed tx operation time.
3567  * @nl80211_WMMR_MAX: highest possible wmm rule.
3568  * @__NL80211_WMMR_LAST: Internal use.
3569  */
3570 enum nl80211_wmm_rule {
3571 	__NL80211_WMMR_INVALID,
3572 	NL80211_WMMR_CW_MIN,
3573 	NL80211_WMMR_CW_MAX,
3574 	NL80211_WMMR_AIFSN,
3575 	NL80211_WMMR_TXOP,
3576 
3577 	/* keep last */
3578 	__NL80211_WMMR_LAST,
3579 	NL80211_WMMR_MAX = __NL80211_WMMR_LAST - 1
3580 };
3581 
3582 /**
3583  * enum nl80211_frequency_attr - frequency attributes
3584  * @__NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3585  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_FREQ: Frequency in MHz
3586  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DISABLED: Channel is disabled in current
3587  *	regulatory domain.
3588  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR: no mechanisms that initiate radiation
3589  * 	are permitted on this channel, this includes sending probe
3590  * 	requests, or modes of operation that require beaconing.
3591  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_RADAR: Radar detection is mandatory
3592  *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
3593  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX_TX_POWER: Maximum transmission power in mBm
3594  *	(100 * dBm).
3595  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_STATE: current state for DFS
3596  *	(enum nl80211_dfs_state)
3597  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_TIME: time in miliseconds for how long
3598  *	this channel is in this DFS state.
3599  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HT40_MINUS: HT40- isn't possible with this
3600  *	channel as the control channel
3601  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HT40_PLUS: HT40+ isn't possible with this
3602  *	channel as the control channel
3603  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_80MHZ: any 80 MHz channel using this channel
3604  *	as the primary or any of the secondary channels isn't possible,
3605  *	this includes 80+80 channels
3606  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_160MHZ: any 160 MHz (but not 80+80) channel
3607  *	using this channel as the primary or any of the secondary channels
3608  *	isn't possible
3609  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_CAC_TIME: DFS CAC time in milliseconds.
3610  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INDOOR_ONLY: Only indoor use is permitted on this
3611  *	channel. A channel that has the INDOOR_ONLY attribute can only be
3612  *	used when there is a clear assessment that the device is operating in
3613  *	an indoor surroundings, i.e., it is connected to AC power (and not
3614  *	through portable DC inverters) or is under the control of a master
3615  *	that is acting as an AP and is connected to AC power.
3616  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT: IR operation is allowed on this
3617  *	channel if it's connected concurrently to a BSS on the same channel on
3618  *	the 2 GHz band or to a channel in the same UNII band (on the 5 GHz
3619  *	band), and IEEE80211_CHAN_RADAR is not set. Instantiating a GO or TDLS
3620  *	off-channel on a channel that has the IR_CONCURRENT attribute set can be
3621  *	done when there is a clear assessment that the device is operating under
3622  *	the guidance of an authorized master, i.e., setting up a GO or TDLS
3623  *	off-channel while the device is also connected to an AP with DFS and
3624  *	radar detection on the UNII band (it is up to user-space, i.e.,
3625  *	wpa_supplicant to perform the required verifications). Using this
3626  *	attribute for IR is disallowed for master interfaces (IBSS, AP).
3627  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_20MHZ: 20 MHz operation is not allowed
3628  *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
3629  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_10MHZ: 10 MHz operation is not allowed
3630  *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
3631  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_WMM: this channel has wmm limitations.
3632  *	This is a nested attribute that contains the wmm limitation per AC.
3633  *	(see &enum nl80211_wmm_rule)
3634  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HE: HE operation is not allowed on this channel
3635  *	in current regulatory domain.
3636  * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX: highest frequency attribute number
3637  *	currently defined
3638  * @__NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
3639  *
3640  * See https://apps.fcc.gov/eas/comments/GetPublishedDocument.html?id=327&tn=528122
3641  * for more information on the FCC description of the relaxations allowed
3642  * by NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INDOOR_ONLY and
3643  * NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT.
3644  */
3645 enum nl80211_frequency_attr {
3646 	__NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INVALID,
3647 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_FREQ,
3648 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DISABLED,
3649 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR,
3650 	__NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IBSS,
3651 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_RADAR,
3652 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX_TX_POWER,
3653 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_STATE,
3654 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_TIME,
3655 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HT40_MINUS,
3656 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HT40_PLUS,
3657 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_80MHZ,
3658 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_160MHZ,
3659 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_CAC_TIME,
3660 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INDOOR_ONLY,
3661 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT,
3662 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_20MHZ,
3663 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_10MHZ,
3664 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_WMM,
3665 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HE,
3666 
3667 	/* keep last */
3668 	__NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
3669 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
3670 };
3671 
3672 #define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX_TX_POWER NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX_TX_POWER
3673 #define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_PASSIVE_SCAN	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR
3674 #define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IBSS		NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR
3675 #define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR		NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR
3676 #define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_GO_CONCURRENT \
3677 					NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT
3678 
3679 /**
3680  * enum nl80211_bitrate_attr - bitrate attributes
3681  * @__NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3682  * @NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_RATE: Bitrate in units of 100 kbps
3683  * @NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_2GHZ_SHORTPREAMBLE: Short preamble supported
3684  *	in 2.4 GHz band.
3685  * @NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_MAX: highest bitrate attribute number
3686  *	currently defined
3687  * @__NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
3688  */
3689 enum nl80211_bitrate_attr {
3690 	__NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_INVALID,
3691 	NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_RATE,
3692 	NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_2GHZ_SHORTPREAMBLE,
3693 
3694 	/* keep last */
3695 	__NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
3696 	NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
3697 };
3698 
3699 /**
3700  * enum nl80211_initiator - Indicates the initiator of a reg domain request
3701  * @NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_CORE: Core queried CRDA for a dynamic world
3702  * 	regulatory domain.
3703  * @NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_USER: User asked the wireless core to set the
3704  * 	regulatory domain.
3705  * @NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_DRIVER: a wireless drivers has hinted to the
3706  * 	wireless core it thinks its knows the regulatory domain we should be in.
3707  * @NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_COUNTRY_IE: the wireless core has received an
3708  * 	802.11 country information element with regulatory information it
3709  * 	thinks we should consider. cfg80211 only processes the country
3710  *	code from the IE, and relies on the regulatory domain information
3711  *	structure passed by userspace (CRDA) from our wireless-regdb.
3712  *	If a channel is enabled but the country code indicates it should
3713  *	be disabled we disable the channel and re-enable it upon disassociation.
3714  */
3715 enum nl80211_reg_initiator {
3716 	NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_CORE,
3717 	NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_USER,
3718 	NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_DRIVER,
3719 	NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_COUNTRY_IE,
3720 };
3721 
3722 /**
3723  * enum nl80211_reg_type - specifies the type of regulatory domain
3724  * @NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_COUNTRY: the regulatory domain set is one that pertains
3725  *	to a specific country. When this is set you can count on the
3726  *	ISO / IEC 3166 alpha2 country code being valid.
3727  * @NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_WORLD: the regulatory set domain is the world regulatory
3728  * 	domain.
3729  * @NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_CUSTOM_WORLD: the regulatory domain set is a custom
3730  * 	driver specific world regulatory domain. These do not apply system-wide
3731  * 	and are only applicable to the individual devices which have requested
3732  * 	them to be applied.
3733  * @NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_INTERSECTION: the regulatory domain set is the product
3734  *	of an intersection between two regulatory domains -- the previously
3735  *	set regulatory domain on the system and the last accepted regulatory
3736  *	domain request to be processed.
3737  */
3738 enum nl80211_reg_type {
3739 	NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_COUNTRY,
3740 	NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_WORLD,
3741 	NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_CUSTOM_WORLD,
3742 	NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_INTERSECTION,
3743 };
3744 
3745 /**
3746  * enum nl80211_reg_rule_attr - regulatory rule attributes
3747  * @__NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3748  * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_FLAGS: a set of flags which specify additional
3749  * 	considerations for a given frequency range. These are the
3750  * 	&enum nl80211_reg_rule_flags.
3751  * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_START: starting frequencry for the regulatory
3752  * 	rule in KHz. This is not a center of frequency but an actual regulatory
3753  * 	band edge.
3754  * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_END: ending frequency for the regulatory rule
3755  * 	in KHz. This is not a center a frequency but an actual regulatory
3756  * 	band edge.
3757  * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_MAX_BW: maximum allowed bandwidth for this
3758  *	frequency range, in KHz.
3759  * @NL80211_ATTR_POWER_RULE_MAX_ANT_GAIN: the maximum allowed antenna gain
3760  * 	for a given frequency range. The value is in mBi (100 * dBi).
3761  * 	If you don't have one then don't send this.
3762  * @NL80211_ATTR_POWER_RULE_MAX_EIRP: the maximum allowed EIRP for
3763  * 	a given frequency range. The value is in mBm (100 * dBm).
3764  * @NL80211_ATTR_DFS_CAC_TIME: DFS CAC time in milliseconds.
3765  *	If not present or 0 default CAC time will be used.
3766  * @NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_MAX: highest regulatory rule attribute number
3767  *	currently defined
3768  * @__NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
3769  */
3770 enum nl80211_reg_rule_attr {
3771 	__NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_INVALID,
3772 	NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_FLAGS,
3773 
3774 	NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_START,
3775 	NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_END,
3776 	NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_MAX_BW,
3777 
3778 	NL80211_ATTR_POWER_RULE_MAX_ANT_GAIN,
3779 	NL80211_ATTR_POWER_RULE_MAX_EIRP,
3780 
3781 	NL80211_ATTR_DFS_CAC_TIME,
3782 
3783 	/* keep last */
3784 	__NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
3785 	NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
3786 };
3787 
3788 /**
3789  * enum nl80211_sched_scan_match_attr - scheduled scan match attributes
3790  * @__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3791  * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_SSID: SSID to be used for matching,
3792  *	only report BSS with matching SSID.
3793  *	(This cannot be used together with BSSID.)
3794  * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RSSI: RSSI threshold (in dBm) for reporting a
3795  *	BSS in scan results. Filtering is turned off if not specified. Note that
3796  *	if this attribute is in a match set of its own, then it is treated as
3797  *	the default value for all matchsets with an SSID, rather than being a
3798  *	matchset of its own without an RSSI filter. This is due to problems with
3799  *	how this API was implemented in the past. Also, due to the same problem,
3800  *	the only way to create a matchset with only an RSSI filter (with this
3801  *	attribute) is if there's only a single matchset with the RSSI attribute.
3802  * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RELATIVE_RSSI: Flag indicating whether
3803  *	%NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RSSI to be used as absolute RSSI or
3804  *	relative to current bss's RSSI.
3805  * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST: When present the RSSI level for
3806  *	BSS-es in the specified band is to be adjusted before doing
3807  *	RSSI-based BSS selection. The attribute value is a packed structure
3808  *	value as specified by &struct nl80211_bss_select_rssi_adjust.
3809  * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_BSSID: BSSID to be used for matching
3810  *	(this cannot be used together with SSID).
3811  * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_PER_BAND_RSSI: Nested attribute that carries the
3812  *	band specific minimum rssi thresholds for the bands defined in
3813  *	enum nl80211_band. The minimum rssi threshold value(s32) specific to a
3814  *	band shall be encapsulated in attribute with type value equals to one
3815  *	of the NL80211_BAND_* defined in enum nl80211_band. For example, the
3816  *	minimum rssi threshold value for 2.4GHZ band shall be encapsulated
3817  *	within an attribute of type NL80211_BAND_2GHZ. And one or more of such
3818  *	attributes will be nested within this attribute.
3819  * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_MAX: highest scheduled scan filter
3820  *	attribute number currently defined
3821  * @__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
3822  */
3823 enum nl80211_sched_scan_match_attr {
3824 	__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_INVALID,
3825 
3826 	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_SSID,
3827 	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RSSI,
3828 	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RELATIVE_RSSI,
3829 	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST,
3830 	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_BSSID,
3831 	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_PER_BAND_RSSI,
3832 
3833 	/* keep last */
3834 	__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
3835 	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_MAX =
3836 		__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
3837 };
3838 
3839 /* only for backward compatibility */
3840 #define NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_SSID NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_SSID
3841 
3842 /**
3843  * enum nl80211_reg_rule_flags - regulatory rule flags
3844  *
3845  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_OFDM: OFDM modulation not allowed
3846  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_CCK: CCK modulation not allowed
3847  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_INDOOR: indoor operation not allowed
3848  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_OUTDOOR: outdoor operation not allowed
3849  * @NL80211_RRF_DFS: DFS support is required to be used
3850  * @NL80211_RRF_PTP_ONLY: this is only for Point To Point links
3851  * @NL80211_RRF_PTMP_ONLY: this is only for Point To Multi Point links
3852  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_IR: no mechanisms that initiate radiation are allowed,
3853  * 	this includes probe requests or modes of operation that require
3854  * 	beaconing.
3855  * @NL80211_RRF_AUTO_BW: maximum available bandwidth should be calculated
3856  *	base on contiguous rules and wider channels will be allowed to cross
3857  *	multiple contiguous/overlapping frequency ranges.
3858  * @NL80211_RRF_IR_CONCURRENT: See %NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT
3859  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40MINUS: channels can't be used in HT40- operation
3860  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40PLUS: channels can't be used in HT40+ operation
3861  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_80MHZ: 80MHz operation not allowed
3862  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_160MHZ: 160MHz operation not allowed
3863  * @NL80211_RRF_NO_HE: HE operation not allowed
3864  */
3865 enum nl80211_reg_rule_flags {
3866 	NL80211_RRF_NO_OFDM		= 1<<0,
3867 	NL80211_RRF_NO_CCK		= 1<<1,
3868 	NL80211_RRF_NO_INDOOR		= 1<<2,
3869 	NL80211_RRF_NO_OUTDOOR		= 1<<3,
3870 	NL80211_RRF_DFS			= 1<<4,
3871 	NL80211_RRF_PTP_ONLY		= 1<<5,
3872 	NL80211_RRF_PTMP_ONLY		= 1<<6,
3873 	NL80211_RRF_NO_IR		= 1<<7,
3874 	__NL80211_RRF_NO_IBSS		= 1<<8,
3875 	NL80211_RRF_AUTO_BW		= 1<<11,
3876 	NL80211_RRF_IR_CONCURRENT	= 1<<12,
3877 	NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40MINUS	= 1<<13,
3878 	NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40PLUS		= 1<<14,
3879 	NL80211_RRF_NO_80MHZ		= 1<<15,
3880 	NL80211_RRF_NO_160MHZ		= 1<<16,
3881 	NL80211_RRF_NO_HE		= 1<<17,
3882 };
3883 
3884 #define NL80211_RRF_PASSIVE_SCAN	NL80211_RRF_NO_IR
3885 #define NL80211_RRF_NO_IBSS		NL80211_RRF_NO_IR
3886 #define NL80211_RRF_NO_IR		NL80211_RRF_NO_IR
3887 #define NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40		(NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40MINUS |\
3888 					 NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40PLUS)
3889 #define NL80211_RRF_GO_CONCURRENT	NL80211_RRF_IR_CONCURRENT
3890 
3891 /* For backport compatibility with older userspace */
3892 #define NL80211_RRF_NO_IR_ALL		(NL80211_RRF_NO_IR | __NL80211_RRF_NO_IBSS)
3893 
3894 /**
3895  * enum nl80211_dfs_regions - regulatory DFS regions
3896  *
3897  * @NL80211_DFS_UNSET: Country has no DFS master region specified
3898  * @NL80211_DFS_FCC: Country follows DFS master rules from FCC
3899  * @NL80211_DFS_ETSI: Country follows DFS master rules from ETSI
3900  * @NL80211_DFS_JP: Country follows DFS master rules from JP/MKK/Telec
3901  */
3902 enum nl80211_dfs_regions {
3903 	NL80211_DFS_UNSET	= 0,
3904 	NL80211_DFS_FCC		= 1,
3905 	NL80211_DFS_ETSI	= 2,
3906 	NL80211_DFS_JP		= 3,
3907 };
3908 
3909 /**
3910  * enum nl80211_user_reg_hint_type - type of user regulatory hint
3911  *
3912  * @NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_USER: a user sent the hint. This is always
3913  *	assumed if the attribute is not set.
3914  * @NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_CELL_BASE: the hint comes from a cellular
3915  *	base station. Device drivers that have been tested to work
3916  *	properly to support this type of hint can enable these hints
3917  *	by setting the NL80211_FEATURE_CELL_BASE_REG_HINTS feature
3918  *	capability on the struct wiphy. The wireless core will
3919  *	ignore all cell base station hints until at least one device
3920  *	present has been registered with the wireless core that
3921  *	has listed NL80211_FEATURE_CELL_BASE_REG_HINTS as a
3922  *	supported feature.
3923  * @NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_INDOOR: a user sent an hint indicating that the
3924  *	platform is operating in an indoor environment.
3925  */
3926 enum nl80211_user_reg_hint_type {
3927 	NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_USER	= 0,
3928 	NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_CELL_BASE = 1,
3929 	NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_INDOOR    = 2,
3930 };
3931 
3932 /**
3933  * enum nl80211_survey_info - survey information
3934  *
3935  * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_ATTR_SURVEY_INFO
3936  * when getting information about a survey.
3937  *
3938  * @__NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3939  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_FREQUENCY: center frequency of channel
3940  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_NOISE: noise level of channel (u8, dBm)
3941  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE: channel is currently being used
3942  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME: amount of time (in ms) that the radio
3943  *	was turned on (on channel or globally)
3944  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY: amount of the time the primary
3945  *	channel was sensed busy (either due to activity or energy detect)
3946  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY: amount of time the extension
3947  *	channel was sensed busy
3948  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX: amount of time the radio spent
3949  *	receiving data (on channel or globally)
3950  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX: amount of time the radio spent
3951  *	transmitting data (on channel or globally)
3952  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN: time the radio spent for scan
3953  *	(on this channel or globally)
3954  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_PAD: attribute used for padding for 64-bit alignment
3955  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX: amount of time the radio spent
3956  *	receiving frames destined to the local BSS
3957  * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_MAX: highest survey info attribute number
3958  *	currently defined
3959  * @__NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_AFTER_LAST: internal use
3960  */
3961 enum nl80211_survey_info {
3962 	__NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_INVALID,
3963 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_FREQUENCY,
3964 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_NOISE,
3965 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE,
3966 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME,
3967 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY,
3968 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY,
3969 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX,
3970 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX,
3971 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN,
3972 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_PAD,
3973 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX,
3974 
3975 	/* keep last */
3976 	__NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_AFTER_LAST,
3977 	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_MAX = __NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_AFTER_LAST - 1
3978 };
3979 
3980 /* keep old names for compatibility */
3981 #define NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_CHANNEL_TIME		NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME
3982 #define NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_CHANNEL_TIME_BUSY		NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY
3983 #define NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_CHANNEL_TIME_EXT_BUSY	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY
3984 #define NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_CHANNEL_TIME_RX		NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX
3985 #define NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_CHANNEL_TIME_TX		NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX
3986 
3987 /**
3988  * enum nl80211_mntr_flags - monitor configuration flags
3989  *
3990  * Monitor configuration flags.
3991  *
3992  * @__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_INVALID: reserved
3993  *
3994  * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_FCSFAIL: pass frames with bad FCS
3995  * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with bad PLCP
3996  * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_CONTROL: pass control frames
3997  * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS: disable BSSID filtering
3998  * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES: report frames after processing.
3999  *	overrides all other flags.
4000  * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_ACTIVE: use the configured MAC address
4001  *	and ACK incoming unicast packets.
4002  *
4003  * @__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4004  * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_MAX: highest possible monitor flag
4005  */
4006 enum nl80211_mntr_flags {
4007 	__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_INVALID,
4008 	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_FCSFAIL,
4009 	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL,
4010 	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_CONTROL,
4011 	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS,
4012 	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES,
4013 	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_ACTIVE,
4014 
4015 	/* keep last */
4016 	__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_AFTER_LAST,
4017 	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_MAX = __NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_AFTER_LAST - 1
4018 };
4019 
4020 /**
4021  * enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode - mesh power save modes
4022  *
4023  * @NL80211_MESH_POWER_UNKNOWN: The mesh power mode of the mesh STA is
4024  *	not known or has not been set yet.
4025  * @NL80211_MESH_POWER_ACTIVE: Active mesh power mode. The mesh STA is
4026  *	in Awake state all the time.
4027  * @NL80211_MESH_POWER_LIGHT_SLEEP: Light sleep mode. The mesh STA will
4028  *	alternate between Active and Doze states, but will wake up for
4029  *	neighbor's beacons.
4030  * @NL80211_MESH_POWER_DEEP_SLEEP: Deep sleep mode. The mesh STA will
4031  *	alternate between Active and Doze states, but may not wake up
4032  *	for neighbor's beacons.
4033  *
4034  * @__NL80211_MESH_POWER_AFTER_LAST - internal use
4035  * @NL80211_MESH_POWER_MAX - highest possible power save level
4036  */
4037 
4038 enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode {
4039 	NL80211_MESH_POWER_UNKNOWN,
4040 	NL80211_MESH_POWER_ACTIVE,
4041 	NL80211_MESH_POWER_LIGHT_SLEEP,
4042 	NL80211_MESH_POWER_DEEP_SLEEP,
4043 
4044 	__NL80211_MESH_POWER_AFTER_LAST,
4045 	NL80211_MESH_POWER_MAX = __NL80211_MESH_POWER_AFTER_LAST - 1
4046 };
4047 
4048 /**
4049  * enum nl80211_meshconf_params - mesh configuration parameters
4050  *
4051  * Mesh configuration parameters. These can be changed while the mesh is
4052  * active.
4053  *
4054  * @__NL80211_MESHCONF_INVALID: internal use
4055  *
4056  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_RETRY_TIMEOUT: specifies the initial retry timeout in
4057  *	millisecond units, used by the Peer Link Open message
4058  *
4059  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_CONFIRM_TIMEOUT: specifies the initial confirm timeout, in
4060  *	millisecond units, used by the peer link management to close a peer link
4061  *
4062  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HOLDING_TIMEOUT: specifies the holding timeout, in
4063  *	millisecond units
4064  *
4065  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_MAX_PEER_LINKS: maximum number of peer links allowed
4066  *	on this mesh interface
4067  *
4068  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_MAX_RETRIES: specifies the maximum number of peer link
4069  *	open retries that can be sent to establish a new peer link instance in a
4070  *	mesh
4071  *
4072  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_TTL: specifies the value of TTL field set at a source mesh
4073  *	point.
4074  *
4075  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_AUTO_OPEN_PLINKS: whether we should automatically open
4076  *	peer links when we detect compatible mesh peers. Disabled if
4077  *	@NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_MPM or @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AMPE are
4078  *	set.
4079  *
4080  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_MAX_PREQ_RETRIES: the number of action frames
4081  *	containing a PREQ that an MP can send to a particular destination (path
4082  *	target)
4083  *
4084  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_PATH_REFRESH_TIME: how frequently to refresh mesh paths
4085  *	(in milliseconds)
4086  *
4087  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_MIN_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT: minimum length of time to wait
4088  *	until giving up on a path discovery (in milliseconds)
4089  *
4090  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ACTIVE_PATH_TIMEOUT: The time (in TUs) for which mesh
4091  *	points receiving a PREQ shall consider the forwarding information from
4092  *	the root to be valid. (TU = time unit)
4093  *
4094  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PREQ_MIN_INTERVAL: The minimum interval of time (in
4095  *	TUs) during which an MP can send only one action frame containing a PREQ
4096  *	reference element
4097  *
4098  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_NET_DIAM_TRVS_TIME: The interval of time (in TUs)
4099  *	that it takes for an HWMP information element to propagate across the
4100  *	mesh
4101  *
4102  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ROOTMODE: whether root mode is enabled or not
4103  *
4104  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_ELEMENT_TTL: specifies the value of TTL field set at a
4105  *	source mesh point for path selection elements.
4106  *
4107  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_RANN_INTERVAL:  The interval of time (in TUs) between
4108  *	root announcements are transmitted.
4109  *
4110  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_GATE_ANNOUNCEMENTS: Advertise that this mesh station has
4111  *	access to a broader network beyond the MBSS.  This is done via Root
4112  *	Announcement frames.
4113  *
4114  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PERR_MIN_INTERVAL: The minimum interval of time (in
4115  *	TUs) during which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame containing a
4116  *	PERR element.
4117  *
4118  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_FORWARDING: set Mesh STA as forwarding or non-forwarding
4119  *	or forwarding entity (default is TRUE - forwarding entity)
4120  *
4121  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_RSSI_THRESHOLD: RSSI threshold in dBm. This specifies the
4122  *	threshold for average signal strength of candidate station to establish
4123  *	a peer link.
4124  *
4125  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_SYNC_OFFSET_MAX_NEIGHBOR: maximum number of neighbors
4126  *	to synchronize to for 11s default synchronization method
4127  *	(see 11C.12.2.2)
4128  *
4129  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HT_OPMODE: set mesh HT protection mode.
4130  *
4131  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_ATTR_MAX: highest possible mesh configuration attribute
4132  *
4133  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PATH_TO_ROOT_TIMEOUT: The time (in TUs) for
4134  *	which mesh STAs receiving a proactive PREQ shall consider the forwarding
4135  *	information to the root mesh STA to be valid.
4136  *
4137  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ROOT_INTERVAL: The interval of time (in TUs) between
4138  *	proactive PREQs are transmitted.
4139  *
4140  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_CONFIRMATION_INTERVAL: The minimum interval of time
4141  *	(in TUs) during which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame
4142  *	containing a PREQ element for root path confirmation.
4143  *
4144  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_POWER_MODE: Default mesh power mode for new peer links.
4145  *	type &enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode (u32)
4146  *
4147  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_AWAKE_WINDOW: awake window duration (in TUs)
4148  *
4149  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_PLINK_TIMEOUT: If no tx activity is seen from a STA we've
4150  *	established peering with for longer than this time (in seconds), then
4151  *	remove it from the STA's list of peers. You may set this to 0 to disable
4152  *	the removal of the STA. Default is 30 minutes.
4153  *
4154  * @NL80211_MESHCONF_CONNECTED_TO_GATE: If set to true then this mesh STA
4155  *	will advertise that it is connected to a gate in the mesh formation
4156  *	field.  If left unset then the mesh formation field will only
4157  *	advertise such if there is an active root mesh path.
4158  *
4159  * @__NL80211_MESHCONF_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4160  */
4161 enum nl80211_meshconf_params {
4162 	__NL80211_MESHCONF_INVALID,
4163 	NL80211_MESHCONF_RETRY_TIMEOUT,
4164 	NL80211_MESHCONF_CONFIRM_TIMEOUT,
4165 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HOLDING_TIMEOUT,
4166 	NL80211_MESHCONF_MAX_PEER_LINKS,
4167 	NL80211_MESHCONF_MAX_RETRIES,
4168 	NL80211_MESHCONF_TTL,
4169 	NL80211_MESHCONF_AUTO_OPEN_PLINKS,
4170 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_MAX_PREQ_RETRIES,
4171 	NL80211_MESHCONF_PATH_REFRESH_TIME,
4172 	NL80211_MESHCONF_MIN_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT,
4173 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ACTIVE_PATH_TIMEOUT,
4174 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PREQ_MIN_INTERVAL,
4175 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_NET_DIAM_TRVS_TIME,
4176 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ROOTMODE,
4177 	NL80211_MESHCONF_ELEMENT_TTL,
4178 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_RANN_INTERVAL,
4179 	NL80211_MESHCONF_GATE_ANNOUNCEMENTS,
4180 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PERR_MIN_INTERVAL,
4181 	NL80211_MESHCONF_FORWARDING,
4182 	NL80211_MESHCONF_RSSI_THRESHOLD,
4183 	NL80211_MESHCONF_SYNC_OFFSET_MAX_NEIGHBOR,
4184 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HT_OPMODE,
4185 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PATH_TO_ROOT_TIMEOUT,
4186 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ROOT_INTERVAL,
4187 	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_CONFIRMATION_INTERVAL,
4188 	NL80211_MESHCONF_POWER_MODE,
4189 	NL80211_MESHCONF_AWAKE_WINDOW,
4190 	NL80211_MESHCONF_PLINK_TIMEOUT,
4191 	NL80211_MESHCONF_CONNECTED_TO_GATE,
4192 
4193 	/* keep last */
4194 	__NL80211_MESHCONF_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
4195 	NL80211_MESHCONF_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_MESHCONF_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
4196 };
4197 
4198 /**
4199  * enum nl80211_mesh_setup_params - mesh setup parameters
4200  *
4201  * Mesh setup parameters.  These are used to start/join a mesh and cannot be
4202  * changed while the mesh is active.
4203  *
4204  * @__NL80211_MESH_SETUP_INVALID: Internal use
4205  *
4206  * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_PATH_SEL: Enable this option to use a
4207  *	vendor specific path selection algorithm or disable it to use the
4208  *	default HWMP.
4209  *
4210  * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_METRIC: Enable this option to use a
4211  *	vendor specific path metric or disable it to use the default Airtime
4212  *	metric.
4213  *
4214  * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_IE: Information elements for this mesh, for instance, a
4215  *	robust security network ie, or a vendor specific information element
4216  *	that vendors will use to identify the path selection methods and
4217  *	metrics in use.
4218  *
4219  * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH: Enable this option if an authentication
4220  *	daemon will be authenticating mesh candidates.
4221  *
4222  * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AMPE: Enable this option if an authentication
4223  *	daemon will be securing peer link frames.  AMPE is a secured version of
4224  *	Mesh Peering Management (MPM) and is implemented with the assistance of
4225  *	a userspace daemon.  When this flag is set, the kernel will send peer
4226  *	management frames to a userspace daemon that will implement AMPE
4227  *	functionality (security capabilities selection, key confirmation, and
4228  *	key management).  When the flag is unset (default), the kernel can
4229  *	autonomously complete (unsecured) mesh peering without the need of a
4230  *	userspace daemon.
4231  *
4232  * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_SYNC: Enable this option to use a
4233  *	vendor specific synchronization method or disable it to use the default
4234  *	neighbor offset synchronization
4235  *
4236  * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_MPM: Enable this option if userspace will
4237  *	implement an MPM which handles peer allocation and state.
4238  *
4239  * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_AUTH_PROTOCOL: Inform the kernel of the authentication
4240  *	method (u8, as defined in IEEE 8.4.2.100.6, e.g. 0x1 for SAE).
4241  *	Default is no authentication method required.
4242  *
4243  * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ATTR_MAX: highest possible mesh setup attribute number
4244  *
4245  * @__NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: Internal use
4246  */
4247 enum nl80211_mesh_setup_params {
4248 	__NL80211_MESH_SETUP_INVALID,
4249 	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_PATH_SEL,
4250 	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_METRIC,
4251 	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_IE,
4252 	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH,
4253 	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AMPE,
4254 	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_SYNC,
4255 	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_MPM,
4256 	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_AUTH_PROTOCOL,
4257 
4258 	/* keep last */
4259 	__NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
4260 	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
4261 };
4262 
4263 /**
4264  * enum nl80211_txq_attr - TX queue parameter attributes
4265  * @__NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_INVALID: Attribute number 0 is reserved
4266  * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AC: AC identifier (NL80211_AC_*)
4267  * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_TXOP: Maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning
4268  *	disabled
4269  * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_CWMIN: Minimum contention window [a value of the form
4270  *	2^n-1 in the range 1..32767]
4271  * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_CWMAX: Maximum contention window [a value of the form
4272  *	2^n-1 in the range 1..32767]
4273  * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AIFS: Arbitration interframe space [0..255]
4274  * @__NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: Internal
4275  * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_MAX: Maximum TXQ attribute number
4276  */
4277 enum nl80211_txq_attr {
4278 	__NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_INVALID,
4279 	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AC,
4280 	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_TXOP,
4281 	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_CWMIN,
4282 	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_CWMAX,
4283 	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AIFS,
4284 
4285 	/* keep last */
4286 	__NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
4287 	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
4288 };
4289 
4290 enum nl80211_ac {
4291 	NL80211_AC_VO,
4292 	NL80211_AC_VI,
4293 	NL80211_AC_BE,
4294 	NL80211_AC_BK,
4295 	NL80211_NUM_ACS
4296 };
4297 
4298 /* backward compat */
4299 #define NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_QUEUE	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AC
4300 #define NL80211_TXQ_Q_VO	NL80211_AC_VO
4301 #define NL80211_TXQ_Q_VI	NL80211_AC_VI
4302 #define NL80211_TXQ_Q_BE	NL80211_AC_BE
4303 #define NL80211_TXQ_Q_BK	NL80211_AC_BK
4304 
4305 /**
4306  * enum nl80211_channel_type - channel type
4307  * @NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT: 20 MHz, non-HT channel
4308  * @NL80211_CHAN_HT20: 20 MHz HT channel
4309  * @NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS: HT40 channel, secondary channel
4310  *	below the control channel
4311  * @NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS: HT40 channel, secondary channel
4312  *	above the control channel
4313  */
4314 enum nl80211_channel_type {
4315 	NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT,
4316 	NL80211_CHAN_HT20,
4317 	NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS,
4318 	NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS
4319 };
4320 
4321 /**
4322  * enum nl80211_key_mode - Key mode
4323  *
4324  * @NL80211_KEY_RX_TX: (Default)
4325  *	Key can be used for Rx and Tx immediately
4326  *
4327  * The following modes can only be selected for unicast keys and when the
4328  * driver supports @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_EXT_KEY_ID:
4329  *
4330  * @NL80211_KEY_NO_TX: Only allowed in combination with @NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY:
4331  *	Unicast key can only be used for Rx, Tx not allowed, yet
4332  * @NL80211_KEY_SET_TX: Only allowed in combination with @NL80211_CMD_SET_KEY:
4333  *	The unicast key identified by idx and mac is cleared for Tx and becomes
4334  *	the preferred Tx key for the station.
4335  */
4336 enum nl80211_key_mode {
4337 	NL80211_KEY_RX_TX,
4338 	NL80211_KEY_NO_TX,
4339 	NL80211_KEY_SET_TX
4340 };
4341 
4342 /**
4343  * enum nl80211_chan_width - channel width definitions
4344  *
4345  * These values are used with the %NL80211_ATTR_CHANNEL_WIDTH
4346  * attribute.
4347  *
4348  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT: 20 MHz, non-HT channel
4349  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20: 20 MHz HT channel
4350  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40: 40 MHz channel, the %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1
4351  *	attribute must be provided as well
4352  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_80: 80 MHz channel, the %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1
4353  *	attribute must be provided as well
4354  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_80P80: 80+80 MHz channel, the %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1
4355  *	and %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ2 attributes must be provided as well
4356  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_160: 160 MHz channel, the %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1
4357  *	attribute must be provided as well
4358  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5: 5 MHz OFDM channel
4359  * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10: 10 MHz OFDM channel
4360  */
4361 enum nl80211_chan_width {
4362 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT,
4363 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20,
4364 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40,
4365 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_80,
4366 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_80P80,
4367 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_160,
4368 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5,
4369 	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10,
4370 };
4371 
4372 /**
4373  * enum nl80211_bss_scan_width - control channel width for a BSS
4374  *
4375  * These values are used with the %NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH attribute.
4376  *
4377  * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_20: control channel is 20 MHz wide or compatible
4378  * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_10: control channel is 10 MHz wide
4379  * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_5: control channel is 5 MHz wide
4380  */
4381 enum nl80211_bss_scan_width {
4382 	NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_20,
4383 	NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_10,
4384 	NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_5,
4385 };
4386 
4387 /**
4388  * enum nl80211_bss - netlink attributes for a BSS
4389  *
4390  * @__NL80211_BSS_INVALID: invalid
4391  * @NL80211_BSS_BSSID: BSSID of the BSS (6 octets)
4392  * @NL80211_BSS_FREQUENCY: frequency in MHz (u32)
4393  * @NL80211_BSS_TSF: TSF of the received probe response/beacon (u64)
4394  *	(if @NL80211_BSS_PRESP_DATA is present then this is known to be
4395  *	from a probe response, otherwise it may be from the same beacon
4396  *	that the NL80211_BSS_BEACON_TSF will be from)
4397  * @NL80211_BSS_BEACON_INTERVAL: beacon interval of the (I)BSS (u16)
4398  * @NL80211_BSS_CAPABILITY: capability field (CPU order, u16)
4399  * @NL80211_BSS_INFORMATION_ELEMENTS: binary attribute containing the
4400  *	raw information elements from the probe response/beacon (bin);
4401  *	if the %NL80211_BSS_BEACON_IES attribute is present and the data is
4402  *	different then the IEs here are from a Probe Response frame; otherwise
4403  *	they are from a Beacon frame.
4404  *	However, if the driver does not indicate the source of the IEs, these
4405  *	IEs may be from either frame subtype.
4406  *	If present, the @NL80211_BSS_PRESP_DATA attribute indicates that the
4407  *	data here is known to be from a probe response, without any heuristics.
4408  * @NL80211_BSS_SIGNAL_MBM: signal strength of probe response/beacon
4409  *	in mBm (100 * dBm) (s32)
4410  * @NL80211_BSS_SIGNAL_UNSPEC: signal strength of the probe response/beacon
4411  *	in unspecified units, scaled to 0..100 (u8)
4412  * @NL80211_BSS_STATUS: status, if this BSS is "used"
4413  * @NL80211_BSS_SEEN_MS_AGO: age of this BSS entry in ms
4414  * @NL80211_BSS_BEACON_IES: binary attribute containing the raw information
4415  *	elements from a Beacon frame (bin); not present if no Beacon frame has
4416  *	yet been received
4417  * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH: channel width of the control channel
4418  *	(u32, enum nl80211_bss_scan_width)
4419  * @NL80211_BSS_BEACON_TSF: TSF of the last received beacon (u64)
4420  *	(not present if no beacon frame has been received yet)
4421  * @NL80211_BSS_PRESP_DATA: the data in @NL80211_BSS_INFORMATION_ELEMENTS and
4422  *	@NL80211_BSS_TSF is known to be from a probe response (flag attribute)
4423  * @NL80211_BSS_LAST_SEEN_BOOTTIME: CLOCK_BOOTTIME timestamp when this entry
4424  *	was last updated by a received frame. The value is expected to be
4425  *	accurate to about 10ms. (u64, nanoseconds)
4426  * @NL80211_BSS_PAD: attribute used for padding for 64-bit alignment
4427  * @NL80211_BSS_PARENT_TSF: the time at the start of reception of the first
4428  *	octet of the timestamp field of the last beacon/probe received for
4429  *	this BSS. The time is the TSF of the BSS specified by
4430  *	@NL80211_BSS_PARENT_BSSID. (u64).
4431  * @NL80211_BSS_PARENT_BSSID: the BSS according to which @NL80211_BSS_PARENT_TSF
4432  *	is set.
4433  * @NL80211_BSS_CHAIN_SIGNAL: per-chain signal strength of last BSS update.
4434  *	Contains a nested array of signal strength attributes (u8, dBm),
4435  *	using the nesting index as the antenna number.
4436  * @__NL80211_BSS_AFTER_LAST: internal
4437  * @NL80211_BSS_MAX: highest BSS attribute
4438  */
4439 enum nl80211_bss {
4440 	__NL80211_BSS_INVALID,
4441 	NL80211_BSS_BSSID,
4442 	NL80211_BSS_FREQUENCY,
4443 	NL80211_BSS_TSF,
4444 	NL80211_BSS_BEACON_INTERVAL,
4445 	NL80211_BSS_CAPABILITY,
4446 	NL80211_BSS_INFORMATION_ELEMENTS,
4447 	NL80211_BSS_SIGNAL_MBM,
4448 	NL80211_BSS_SIGNAL_UNSPEC,
4449 	NL80211_BSS_STATUS,
4450 	NL80211_BSS_SEEN_MS_AGO,
4451 	NL80211_BSS_BEACON_IES,
4452 	NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH,
4453 	NL80211_BSS_BEACON_TSF,
4454 	NL80211_BSS_PRESP_DATA,
4455 	NL80211_BSS_LAST_SEEN_BOOTTIME,
4456 	NL80211_BSS_PAD,
4457 	NL80211_BSS_PARENT_TSF,
4458 	NL80211_BSS_PARENT_BSSID,
4459 	NL80211_BSS_CHAIN_SIGNAL,
4460 
4461 	/* keep last */
4462 	__NL80211_BSS_AFTER_LAST,
4463 	NL80211_BSS_MAX = __NL80211_BSS_AFTER_LAST - 1
4464 };
4465 
4466 /**
4467  * enum nl80211_bss_status - BSS "status"
4468  * @NL80211_BSS_STATUS_AUTHENTICATED: Authenticated with this BSS.
4469  *	Note that this is no longer used since cfg80211 no longer
4470  *	keeps track of whether or not authentication was done with
4471  *	a given BSS.
4472  * @NL80211_BSS_STATUS_ASSOCIATED: Associated with this BSS.
4473  * @NL80211_BSS_STATUS_IBSS_JOINED: Joined to this IBSS.
4474  *
4475  * The BSS status is a BSS attribute in scan dumps, which
4476  * indicates the status the interface has wrt. this BSS.
4477  */
4478 enum nl80211_bss_status {
4479 	NL80211_BSS_STATUS_AUTHENTICATED,
4480 	NL80211_BSS_STATUS_ASSOCIATED,
4481 	NL80211_BSS_STATUS_IBSS_JOINED,
4482 };
4483 
4484 /**
4485  * enum nl80211_auth_type - AuthenticationType
4486  *
4487  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_OPEN_SYSTEM: Open System authentication
4488  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_SHARED_KEY: Shared Key authentication (WEP only)
4489  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FT: Fast BSS Transition (IEEE 802.11r)
4490  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_NETWORK_EAP: Network EAP (some Cisco APs and mainly LEAP)
4491  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_SAE: Simultaneous authentication of equals
4492  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_SK: Fast Initial Link Setup shared key
4493  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_SK_PFS: Fast Initial Link Setup shared key with PFS
4494  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_PK: Fast Initial Link Setup public key
4495  * @__NL80211_AUTHTYPE_NUM: internal
4496  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_MAX: maximum valid auth algorithm
4497  * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_AUTOMATIC: determine automatically (if necessary by
4498  *	trying multiple times); this is invalid in netlink -- leave out
4499  *	the attribute for this on CONNECT commands.
4500  */
4501 enum nl80211_auth_type {
4502 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_OPEN_SYSTEM,
4503 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_SHARED_KEY,
4504 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FT,
4505 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_NETWORK_EAP,
4506 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_SAE,
4507 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_SK,
4508 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_SK_PFS,
4509 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_PK,
4510 
4511 	/* keep last */
4512 	__NL80211_AUTHTYPE_NUM,
4513 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_MAX = __NL80211_AUTHTYPE_NUM - 1,
4514 	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_AUTOMATIC
4515 };
4516 
4517 /**
4518  * enum nl80211_key_type - Key Type
4519  * @NL80211_KEYTYPE_GROUP: Group (broadcast/multicast) key
4520  * @NL80211_KEYTYPE_PAIRWISE: Pairwise (unicast/individual) key
4521  * @NL80211_KEYTYPE_PEERKEY: PeerKey (DLS)
4522  * @NUM_NL80211_KEYTYPES: number of defined key types
4523  */
4524 enum nl80211_key_type {
4525 	NL80211_KEYTYPE_GROUP,
4526 	NL80211_KEYTYPE_PAIRWISE,
4527 	NL80211_KEYTYPE_PEERKEY,
4528 
4529 	NUM_NL80211_KEYTYPES
4530 };
4531 
4532 /**
4533  * enum nl80211_mfp - Management frame protection state
4534  * @NL80211_MFP_NO: Management frame protection not used
4535  * @NL80211_MFP_REQUIRED: Management frame protection required
4536  * @NL80211_MFP_OPTIONAL: Management frame protection is optional
4537  */
4538 enum nl80211_mfp {
4539 	NL80211_MFP_NO,
4540 	NL80211_MFP_REQUIRED,
4541 	NL80211_MFP_OPTIONAL,
4542 };
4543 
4544 enum nl80211_wpa_versions {
4545 	NL80211_WPA_VERSION_1 = 1 << 0,
4546 	NL80211_WPA_VERSION_2 = 1 << 1,
4547 	NL80211_WPA_VERSION_3 = 1 << 2,
4548 };
4549 
4550 /**
4551  * enum nl80211_key_default_types - key default types
4552  * @__NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_INVALID: invalid
4553  * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_UNICAST: key should be used as default
4554  *	unicast key
4555  * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_MULTICAST: key should be used as default
4556  *	multicast key
4557  * @NUM_NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES: number of default types
4558  */
4559 enum nl80211_key_default_types {
4560 	__NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_INVALID,
4561 	NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_UNICAST,
4562 	NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_MULTICAST,
4563 
4564 	NUM_NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES
4565 };
4566 
4567 /**
4568  * enum nl80211_key_attributes - key attributes
4569  * @__NL80211_KEY_INVALID: invalid
4570  * @NL80211_KEY_DATA: (temporal) key data; for TKIP this consists of
4571  *	16 bytes encryption key followed by 8 bytes each for TX and RX MIC
4572  *	keys
4573  * @NL80211_KEY_IDX: key ID (u8, 0-3)
4574  * @NL80211_KEY_CIPHER: key cipher suite (u32, as defined by IEEE 802.11
4575  *	section 7.3.2.25.1, e.g. 0x000FAC04)
4576  * @NL80211_KEY_SEQ: transmit key sequence number (IV/PN) for TKIP and
4577  *	CCMP keys, each six bytes in little endian
4578  * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT: flag indicating default key
4579  * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_MGMT: flag indicating default management key
4580  * @NL80211_KEY_TYPE: the key type from enum nl80211_key_type, if not
4581  *	specified the default depends on whether a MAC address was
4582  *	given with the command using the key or not (u32)
4583  * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES: A nested attribute containing flags
4584  *	attributes, specifying what a key should be set as default as.
4585  *	See &enum nl80211_key_default_types.
4586  * @NL80211_KEY_MODE: the mode from enum nl80211_key_mode.
4587  *	Defaults to @NL80211_KEY_RX_TX.
4588  * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_BEACON: flag indicating default Beacon frame key
4589  *
4590  * @__NL80211_KEY_AFTER_LAST: internal
4591  * @NL80211_KEY_MAX: highest key attribute
4592  */
4593 enum nl80211_key_attributes {
4594 	__NL80211_KEY_INVALID,
4595 	NL80211_KEY_DATA,
4596 	NL80211_KEY_IDX,
4597 	NL80211_KEY_CIPHER,
4598 	NL80211_KEY_SEQ,
4599 	NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT,
4600 	NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_MGMT,
4601 	NL80211_KEY_TYPE,
4602 	NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES,
4603 	NL80211_KEY_MODE,
4604 	NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_BEACON,
4605 
4606 	/* keep last */
4607 	__NL80211_KEY_AFTER_LAST,
4608 	NL80211_KEY_MAX = __NL80211_KEY_AFTER_LAST - 1
4609 };
4610 
4611 /**
4612  * enum nl80211_tx_rate_attributes - TX rate set attributes
4613  * @__NL80211_TXRATE_INVALID: invalid
4614  * @NL80211_TXRATE_LEGACY: Legacy (non-MCS) rates allowed for TX rate selection
4615  *	in an array of rates as defined in IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.2 (u8 values with
4616  *	1 = 500 kbps) but without the IE length restriction (at most
4617  *	%NL80211_MAX_SUPP_RATES in a single array).
4618  * @NL80211_TXRATE_HT: HT (MCS) rates allowed for TX rate selection
4619  *	in an array of MCS numbers.
4620  * @NL80211_TXRATE_VHT: VHT rates allowed for TX rate selection,
4621  *	see &struct nl80211_txrate_vht
4622  * @NL80211_TXRATE_GI: configure GI, see &enum nl80211_txrate_gi
4623  * @__NL80211_TXRATE_AFTER_LAST: internal
4624  * @NL80211_TXRATE_MAX: highest TX rate attribute
4625  */
4626 enum nl80211_tx_rate_attributes {
4627 	__NL80211_TXRATE_INVALID,
4628 	NL80211_TXRATE_LEGACY,
4629 	NL80211_TXRATE_HT,
4630 	NL80211_TXRATE_VHT,
4631 	NL80211_TXRATE_GI,
4632 
4633 	/* keep last */
4634 	__NL80211_TXRATE_AFTER_LAST,
4635 	NL80211_TXRATE_MAX = __NL80211_TXRATE_AFTER_LAST - 1
4636 };
4637 
4638 #define NL80211_TXRATE_MCS NL80211_TXRATE_HT
4639 #define NL80211_VHT_NSS_MAX		8
4640 
4641 /**
4642  * struct nl80211_txrate_vht - VHT MCS/NSS txrate bitmap
4643  * @mcs: MCS bitmap table for each NSS (array index 0 for 1 stream, etc.)
4644  */
4645 struct nl80211_txrate_vht {
4646 	__u16 mcs[NL80211_VHT_NSS_MAX];
4647 };
4648 
4649 enum nl80211_txrate_gi {
4650 	NL80211_TXRATE_DEFAULT_GI,
4651 	NL80211_TXRATE_FORCE_SGI,
4652 	NL80211_TXRATE_FORCE_LGI,
4653 };
4654 
4655 /**
4656  * enum nl80211_band - Frequency band
4657  * @NL80211_BAND_2GHZ: 2.4 GHz ISM band
4658  * @NL80211_BAND_5GHZ: around 5 GHz band (4.9 - 5.7 GHz)
4659  * @NL80211_BAND_60GHZ: around 60 GHz band (58.32 - 69.12 GHz)
4660  * @NL80211_BAND_6GHZ: around 6 GHz band (5.9 - 7.2 GHz)
4661  * @NUM_NL80211_BANDS: number of bands, avoid using this in userspace
4662  *	since newer kernel versions may support more bands
4663  */
4664 enum nl80211_band {
4665 	NL80211_BAND_2GHZ,
4666 	NL80211_BAND_5GHZ,
4667 	NL80211_BAND_60GHZ,
4668 	NL80211_BAND_6GHZ,
4669 
4670 	NUM_NL80211_BANDS,
4671 };
4672 
4673 /**
4674  * enum nl80211_ps_state - powersave state
4675  * @NL80211_PS_DISABLED: powersave is disabled
4676  * @NL80211_PS_ENABLED: powersave is enabled
4677  */
4678 enum nl80211_ps_state {
4679 	NL80211_PS_DISABLED,
4680 	NL80211_PS_ENABLED,
4681 };
4682 
4683 /**
4684  * enum nl80211_attr_cqm - connection quality monitor attributes
4685  * @__NL80211_ATTR_CQM_INVALID: invalid
4686  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_THOLD: RSSI threshold in dBm. This value specifies
4687  *	the threshold for the RSSI level at which an event will be sent. Zero
4688  *	to disable.  Alternatively, if %NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CQM_RSSI_LIST is
4689  *	set, multiple values can be supplied as a low-to-high sorted array of
4690  *	threshold values in dBm.  Events will be sent when the RSSI value
4691  *	crosses any of the thresholds.
4692  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_HYST: RSSI hysteresis in dBm. This value specifies
4693  *	the minimum amount the RSSI level must change after an event before a
4694  *	new event may be issued (to reduce effects of RSSI oscillation).
4695  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT: RSSI threshold event
4696  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_PKT_LOSS_EVENT: a u32 value indicating that this many
4697  *	consecutive packets were not acknowledged by the peer
4698  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_RATE: TX error rate in %. Minimum % of TX failures
4699  *	during the given %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_INTVL before an
4700  *	%NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_CQM with reported %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_RATE and
4701  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_PKTS is generated.
4702  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_PKTS: number of attempted packets in a given
4703  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_INTVL before %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_RATE is
4704  *	checked.
4705  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_INTVL: interval in seconds. Specifies the periodic
4706  *	interval in which %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_PKTS and
4707  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_RATE must be satisfied before generating an
4708  *	%NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_CQM. Set to 0 to turn off TX error reporting.
4709  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_BEACON_LOSS_EVENT: flag attribute that's set in a beacon
4710  *	loss event
4711  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_LEVEL: the RSSI value in dBm that triggered the
4712  *	RSSI threshold event.
4713  * @__NL80211_ATTR_CQM_AFTER_LAST: internal
4714  * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_MAX: highest key attribute
4715  */
4716 enum nl80211_attr_cqm {
4717 	__NL80211_ATTR_CQM_INVALID,
4718 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_THOLD,
4719 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_HYST,
4720 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT,
4721 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_PKT_LOSS_EVENT,
4722 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_RATE,
4723 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_PKTS,
4724 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_INTVL,
4725 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_BEACON_LOSS_EVENT,
4726 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_LEVEL,
4727 
4728 	/* keep last */
4729 	__NL80211_ATTR_CQM_AFTER_LAST,
4730 	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_MAX = __NL80211_ATTR_CQM_AFTER_LAST - 1
4731 };
4732 
4733 /**
4734  * enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event - RSSI threshold event
4735  * @NL80211_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT_LOW: The RSSI level is lower than the
4736  *      configured threshold
4737  * @NL80211_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT_HIGH: The RSSI is higher than the
4738  *      configured threshold
4739  * @NL80211_CQM_RSSI_BEACON_LOSS_EVENT: (reserved, never sent)
4740  */
4741 enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event {
4742 	NL80211_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT_LOW,
4743 	NL80211_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT_HIGH,
4744 	NL80211_CQM_RSSI_BEACON_LOSS_EVENT,
4745 };
4746 
4747 
4748 /**
4749  * enum nl80211_tx_power_setting - TX power adjustment
4750  * @NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC: automatically determine transmit power
4751  * @NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED: limit TX power by the mBm parameter
4752  * @NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED: fix TX power to the mBm parameter
4753  */
4754 enum nl80211_tx_power_setting {
4755 	NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC,
4756 	NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED,
4757 	NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED,
4758 };
4759 
4760 /**
4761  * enum nl80211_tid_config - TID config state
4762  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ENABLE: Enable config for the TID
4763  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_DISABLE: Disable config for the TID
4764  */
4765 enum nl80211_tid_config {
4766 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ENABLE,
4767 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_DISABLE,
4768 };
4769 
4770 /* enum nl80211_tid_config_attr - TID specific configuration.
4771  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_PAD: pad attribute for 64-bit values
4772  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_VIF_SUPP: a bitmap (u64) of attributes supported
4773  *	for per-vif configuration; doesn't list the ones that are generic
4774  *	(%NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS, %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_OVERRIDE).
4775  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_PEER_SUPP: same as the previous per-vif one, but
4776  *	per peer instead.
4777  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_OVERRIDE: flag attribue, if no peer
4778  *	is selected, if set indicates that the new configuration overrides
4779  *	all previous peer configurations, otherwise previous peer specific
4780  *	configurations should be left untouched. If peer is selected then
4781  *	it will reset particular TID configuration of that peer and it will
4782  *	not accept other TID config attributes along with peer.
4783  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS: a bitmask value of TIDs (bit 0 to 7)
4784  *	Its type is u16.
4785  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_NOACK: Configure ack policy for the TID.
4786  *	specified in %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TID. see %enum nl80211_tid_config.
4787  *	Its type is u8.
4788  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_SHORT: Number of retries used with data frame
4789  *	transmission, user-space sets this configuration in
4790  *	&NL80211_CMD_SET_TID_CONFIG. It is u8 type, min value is 1 and
4791  *	the max value is advertised by the driver in this attribute on
4792  *	output in wiphy capabilities.
4793  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_LONG: Number of retries used with data frame
4794  *	transmission, user-space sets this configuration in
4795  *	&NL80211_CMD_SET_TID_CONFIG. Its type is u8, min value is 1 and
4796  *	the max value is advertised by the driver in this attribute on
4797  *	output in wiphy capabilities.
4798  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_AMPDU_CTRL: Enable/Disable aggregation for the TIDs
4799  *	specified in %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS. Its type is u8, using
4800  *	the values from &nl80211_tid_config.
4801  * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RTSCTS_CTRL: Enable/Disable RTS_CTS for the TIDs
4802  *	specified in %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS. It is u8 type, using
4803  *	the values from &nl80211_tid_config.
4804  */
4805 enum nl80211_tid_config_attr {
4806 	__NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_INVALID,
4807 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_PAD,
4808 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_VIF_SUPP,
4809 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_PEER_SUPP,
4810 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_OVERRIDE,
4811 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS,
4812 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_NOACK,
4813 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_SHORT,
4814 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_LONG,
4815 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_AMPDU_CTRL,
4816 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RTSCTS_CTRL,
4817 
4818 	/* keep last */
4819 	__NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
4820 	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
4821 };
4822 
4823 /**
4824  * enum nl80211_packet_pattern_attr - packet pattern attribute
4825  * @__NL80211_PKTPAT_INVALID: invalid number for nested attribute
4826  * @NL80211_PKTPAT_PATTERN: the pattern, values where the mask has
4827  *	a zero bit are ignored
4828  * @NL80211_PKTPAT_MASK: pattern mask, must be long enough to have
4829  *	a bit for each byte in the pattern. The lowest-order bit corresponds
4830  *	to the first byte of the pattern, but the bytes of the pattern are
4831  *	in a little-endian-like format, i.e. the 9th byte of the pattern
4832  *	corresponds to the lowest-order bit in the second byte of the mask.
4833  *	For example: The match 00:xx:00:00:xx:00:00:00:00:xx:xx:xx (where
4834  *	xx indicates "don't care") would be represented by a pattern of
4835  *	twelve zero bytes, and a mask of "0xed,0x01".
4836  *	Note that the pattern matching is done as though frames were not
4837  *	802.11 frames but 802.3 frames, i.e. the frame is fully unpacked
4838  *	first (including SNAP header unpacking) and then matched.
4839  * @NL80211_PKTPAT_OFFSET: packet offset, pattern is matched after
4840  *	these fixed number of bytes of received packet
4841  * @NUM_NL80211_PKTPAT: number of attributes
4842  * @MAX_NL80211_PKTPAT: max attribute number
4843  */
4844 enum nl80211_packet_pattern_attr {
4845 	__NL80211_PKTPAT_INVALID,
4846 	NL80211_PKTPAT_MASK,
4847 	NL80211_PKTPAT_PATTERN,
4848 	NL80211_PKTPAT_OFFSET,
4849 
4850 	NUM_NL80211_PKTPAT,
4851 	MAX_NL80211_PKTPAT = NUM_NL80211_PKTPAT - 1,
4852 };
4853 
4854 /**
4855  * struct nl80211_pattern_support - packet pattern support information
4856  * @max_patterns: maximum number of patterns supported
4857  * @min_pattern_len: minimum length of each pattern
4858  * @max_pattern_len: maximum length of each pattern
4859  * @max_pkt_offset: maximum Rx packet offset
4860  *
4861  * This struct is carried in %NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_PKT_PATTERN when
4862  * that is part of %NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS_SUPPORTED or in
4863  * %NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_PKT_PATTERN when that is part of
4864  * %NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE in the capability information given
4865  * by the kernel to userspace.
4866  */
4867 struct nl80211_pattern_support {
4868 	__u32 max_patterns;
4869 	__u32 min_pattern_len;
4870 	__u32 max_pattern_len;
4871 	__u32 max_pkt_offset;
4872 } __attribute__((packed));
4873 
4874 /* only for backward compatibility */
4875 #define __NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT_INVALID __NL80211_PKTPAT_INVALID
4876 #define NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT_MASK NL80211_PKTPAT_MASK
4877 #define NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT_PATTERN NL80211_PKTPAT_PATTERN
4878 #define NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT_OFFSET NL80211_PKTPAT_OFFSET
4879 #define NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT NUM_NL80211_PKTPAT
4880 #define MAX_NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT MAX_NL80211_PKTPAT
4881 #define nl80211_wowlan_pattern_support nl80211_pattern_support
4882 
4883 /**
4884  * enum nl80211_wowlan_triggers - WoWLAN trigger definitions
4885  * @__NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_INVALID: invalid number for nested attributes
4886  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_ANY: wake up on any activity, do not really put
4887  *	the chip into a special state -- works best with chips that have
4888  *	support for low-power operation already (flag)
4889  *	Note that this mode is incompatible with all of the others, if
4890  *	any others are even supported by the device.
4891  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_DISCONNECT: wake up on disconnect, the way disconnect
4892  *	is detected is implementation-specific (flag)
4893  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_MAGIC_PKT: wake up on magic packet (6x 0xff, followed
4894  *	by 16 repetitions of MAC addr, anywhere in payload) (flag)
4895  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_PKT_PATTERN: wake up on the specified packet patterns
4896  *	which are passed in an array of nested attributes, each nested attribute
4897  *	defining a with attributes from &struct nl80211_wowlan_trig_pkt_pattern.
4898  *	Each pattern defines a wakeup packet. Packet offset is associated with
4899  *	each pattern which is used while matching the pattern. The matching is
4900  *	done on the MSDU, i.e. as though the packet was an 802.3 packet, so the
4901  *	pattern matching is done after the packet is converted to the MSDU.
4902  *
4903  *	In %NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS_SUPPORTED, it is a binary attribute
4904  *	carrying a &struct nl80211_pattern_support.
4905  *
4906  *	When reporting wakeup. it is a u32 attribute containing the 0-based
4907  *	index of the pattern that caused the wakeup, in the patterns passed
4908  *	to the kernel when configuring.
4909  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_GTK_REKEY_SUPPORTED: Not a real trigger, and cannot be
4910  *	used when setting, used only to indicate that GTK rekeying is supported
4911  *	by the device (flag)
4912  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE: wake up on GTK rekey failure (if
4913  *	done by the device) (flag)
4914  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_EAP_IDENT_REQUEST: wake up on EAP Identity Request
4915  *	packet (flag)
4916  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_4WAY_HANDSHAKE: wake up on 4-way handshake (flag)
4917  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_RFKILL_RELEASE: wake up when rfkill is released
4918  *	(on devices that have rfkill in the device) (flag)
4919  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211: For wakeup reporting only, contains
4920  *	the 802.11 packet that caused the wakeup, e.g. a deauth frame. The frame
4921  *	may be truncated, the @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211_LEN
4922  *	attribute contains the original length.
4923  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211_LEN: Original length of the 802.11
4924  *	packet, may be bigger than the @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211
4925  *	attribute if the packet was truncated somewhere.
4926  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023: For wakeup reporting only, contains the
4927  *	802.11 packet that caused the wakeup, e.g. a magic packet. The frame may
4928  *	be truncated, the @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023_LEN attribute
4929  *	contains the original length.
4930  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023_LEN: Original length of the 802.3
4931  *	packet, may be bigger than the @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023
4932  *	attribute if the packet was truncated somewhere.
4933  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_TCP_CONNECTION: TCP connection wake, see DOC section
4934  *	"TCP connection wakeup" for more details. This is a nested attribute
4935  *	containing the exact information for establishing and keeping alive
4936  *	the TCP connection.
4937  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_TCP_WAKEUP_MATCH: For wakeup reporting only, the
4938  *	wakeup packet was received on the TCP connection
4939  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_TCP_CONNLOST: For wakeup reporting only, the
4940  *	TCP connection was lost or failed to be established
4941  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_TCP_NOMORETOKENS: For wakeup reporting only,
4942  *	the TCP connection ran out of tokens to use for data to send to the
4943  *	service
4944  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_NET_DETECT: wake up when a configured network
4945  *	is detected.  This is a nested attribute that contains the
4946  *	same attributes used with @NL80211_CMD_START_SCHED_SCAN.  It
4947  *	specifies how the scan is performed (e.g. the interval, the
4948  *	channels to scan and the initial delay) as well as the scan
4949  *	results that will trigger a wake (i.e. the matchsets).  This
4950  *	attribute is also sent in a response to
4951  *	@NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY, indicating the number of match sets
4952  *	supported by the driver (u32).
4953  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_NET_DETECT_RESULTS: nested attribute
4954  *	containing an array with information about what triggered the
4955  *	wake up.  If no elements are present in the array, it means
4956  *	that the information is not available.  If more than one
4957  *	element is present, it means that more than one match
4958  *	occurred.
4959  *	Each element in the array is a nested attribute that contains
4960  *	one optional %NL80211_ATTR_SSID attribute and one optional
4961  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES attribute.  At least one of
4962  *	these attributes must be present.  If
4963  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES contains more than one
4964  *	frequency, it means that the match occurred in more than one
4965  *	channel.
4966  * @NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG: number of wake on wireless triggers
4967  * @MAX_NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG: highest wowlan trigger attribute number
4968  *
4969  * These nested attributes are used to configure the wakeup triggers and
4970  * to report the wakeup reason(s).
4971  */
4972 enum nl80211_wowlan_triggers {
4973 	__NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_INVALID,
4974 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_ANY,
4975 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_DISCONNECT,
4976 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_MAGIC_PKT,
4977 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_PKT_PATTERN,
4978 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_GTK_REKEY_SUPPORTED,
4979 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE,
4980 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_EAP_IDENT_REQUEST,
4981 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_4WAY_HANDSHAKE,
4982 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_RFKILL_RELEASE,
4983 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211,
4984 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211_LEN,
4985 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023,
4986 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023_LEN,
4987 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_TCP_CONNECTION,
4988 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_TCP_MATCH,
4989 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_TCP_CONNLOST,
4990 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_TCP_NOMORETOKENS,
4991 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_NET_DETECT,
4992 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_NET_DETECT_RESULTS,
4993 
4994 	/* keep last */
4995 	NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG,
4996 	MAX_NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG = NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG - 1
4997 };
4998 
4999 /**
5000  * DOC: TCP connection wakeup
5001  *
5002  * Some devices can establish a TCP connection in order to be woken up by a
5003  * packet coming in from outside their network segment, or behind NAT. If
5004  * configured, the device will establish a TCP connection to the given
5005  * service, and periodically send data to that service. The first data
5006  * packet is usually transmitted after SYN/ACK, also ACKing the SYN/ACK.
5007  * The data packets can optionally include a (little endian) sequence
5008  * number (in the TCP payload!) that is generated by the device, and, also
5009  * optionally, a token from a list of tokens. This serves as a keep-alive
5010  * with the service, and for NATed connections, etc.
5011  *
5012  * During this keep-alive period, the server doesn't send any data to the
5013  * client. When receiving data, it is compared against the wakeup pattern
5014  * (and mask) and if it matches, the host is woken up. Similarly, if the
5015  * connection breaks or cannot be established to start with, the host is
5016  * also woken up.
5017  *
5018  * Developer's note: ARP offload is required for this, otherwise TCP
5019  * response packets might not go through correctly.
5020  */
5021 
5022 /**
5023  * struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_seq - WoWLAN TCP data sequence
5024  * @start: starting value
5025  * @offset: offset of sequence number in packet
5026  * @len: length of the sequence value to write, 1 through 4
5027  *
5028  * Note: don't confuse with the TCP sequence number(s), this is for the
5029  * keepalive packet payload. The actual value is written into the packet
5030  * in little endian.
5031  */
5032 struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_seq {
5033 	__u32 start, offset, len;
5034 };
5035 
5036 /**
5037  * struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token - WoWLAN TCP data token config
5038  * @offset: offset of token in packet
5039  * @len: length of each token
5040  * @token_stream: stream of data to be used for the tokens, the length must
5041  *	be a multiple of @len for this to make sense
5042  */
5043 struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token {
5044 	__u32 offset, len;
5045 	__u8 token_stream[];
5046 };
5047 
5048 /**
5049  * struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token_feature - data token features
5050  * @min_len: minimum token length
5051  * @max_len: maximum token length
5052  * @bufsize: total available token buffer size (max size of @token_stream)
5053  */
5054 struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token_feature {
5055 	__u32 min_len, max_len, bufsize;
5056 };
5057 
5058 /**
5059  * enum nl80211_wowlan_tcp_attrs - WoWLAN TCP connection parameters
5060  * @__NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_INVALID: invalid number for nested attributes
5061  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_SRC_IPV4: source IPv4 address (in network byte order)
5062  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_IPV4: destination IPv4 address
5063  *	(in network byte order)
5064  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_MAC: destination MAC address, this is given because
5065  *	route lookup when configured might be invalid by the time we suspend,
5066  *	and doing a route lookup when suspending is no longer possible as it
5067  *	might require ARP querying.
5068  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_SRC_PORT: source port (u16); optional, if not given a
5069  *	socket and port will be allocated
5070  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_PORT: destination port (u16)
5071  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD: data packet payload, at least one byte.
5072  *	For feature advertising, a u32 attribute holding the maximum length
5073  *	of the data payload.
5074  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD_SEQ: data packet sequence configuration
5075  *	(if desired), a &struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_seq. For feature
5076  *	advertising it is just a flag
5077  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD_TOKEN: data packet token configuration,
5078  *	see &struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token and for advertising see
5079  *	&struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token_feature.
5080  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_INTERVAL: data interval in seconds, maximum
5081  *	interval in feature advertising (u32)
5082  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_WAKE_PAYLOAD: wake packet payload, for advertising a
5083  *	u32 attribute holding the maximum length
5084  * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_WAKE_MASK: Wake packet payload mask, not used for
5085  *	feature advertising. The mask works like @NL80211_PKTPAT_MASK
5086  *	but on the TCP payload only.
5087  * @NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP: number of TCP attributes
5088  * @MAX_NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP: highest attribute number
5089  */
5090 enum nl80211_wowlan_tcp_attrs {
5091 	__NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_INVALID,
5092 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_SRC_IPV4,
5093 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_IPV4,
5094 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_MAC,
5095 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_SRC_PORT,
5096 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_PORT,
5097 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD,
5098 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD_SEQ,
5099 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD_TOKEN,
5100 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_INTERVAL,
5101 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_WAKE_PAYLOAD,
5102 	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_WAKE_MASK,
5103 
5104 	/* keep last */
5105 	NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP,
5106 	MAX_NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP = NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP - 1
5107 };
5108 
5109 /**
5110  * struct nl80211_coalesce_rule_support - coalesce rule support information
5111  * @max_rules: maximum number of rules supported
5112  * @pat: packet pattern support information
5113  * @max_delay: maximum supported coalescing delay in msecs
5114  *
5115  * This struct is carried in %NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE in the
5116  * capability information given by the kernel to userspace.
5117  */
5118 struct nl80211_coalesce_rule_support {
5119 	__u32 max_rules;
5120 	struct nl80211_pattern_support pat;
5121 	__u32 max_delay;
5122 } __attribute__((packed));
5123 
5124 /**
5125  * enum nl80211_attr_coalesce_rule - coalesce rule attribute
5126  * @__NL80211_COALESCE_RULE_INVALID: invalid number for nested attribute
5127  * @NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_DELAY: delay in msecs used for packet coalescing
5128  * @NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_CONDITION: condition for packet coalescence,
5129  *	see &enum nl80211_coalesce_condition.
5130  * @NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_PKT_PATTERN: packet offset, pattern is matched
5131  *	after these fixed number of bytes of received packet
5132  * @NUM_NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE: number of attributes
5133  * @NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_MAX: max attribute number
5134  */
5135 enum nl80211_attr_coalesce_rule {
5136 	__NL80211_COALESCE_RULE_INVALID,
5137 	NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_DELAY,
5138 	NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_CONDITION,
5139 	NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_PKT_PATTERN,
5140 
5141 	/* keep last */
5142 	NUM_NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE,
5143 	NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_MAX = NUM_NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE - 1
5144 };
5145 
5146 /**
5147  * enum nl80211_coalesce_condition - coalesce rule conditions
5148  * @NL80211_COALESCE_CONDITION_MATCH: coalaesce Rx packets when patterns
5149  *	in a rule are matched.
5150  * @NL80211_COALESCE_CONDITION_NO_MATCH: coalesce Rx packets when patterns
5151  *	in a rule are not matched.
5152  */
5153 enum nl80211_coalesce_condition {
5154 	NL80211_COALESCE_CONDITION_MATCH,
5155 	NL80211_COALESCE_CONDITION_NO_MATCH
5156 };
5157 
5158 /**
5159  * enum nl80211_iface_limit_attrs - limit attributes
5160  * @NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_UNSPEC: (reserved)
5161  * @NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_MAX: maximum number of interfaces that
5162  *	can be chosen from this set of interface types (u32)
5163  * @NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_TYPES: nested attribute containing a
5164  *	flag attribute for each interface type in this set
5165  * @NUM_NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT: number of attributes
5166  * @MAX_NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT: highest attribute number
5167  */
5168 enum nl80211_iface_limit_attrs {
5169 	NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_UNSPEC,
5170 	NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_MAX,
5171 	NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_TYPES,
5172 
5173 	/* keep last */
5174 	NUM_NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT,
5175 	MAX_NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT = NUM_NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT - 1
5176 };
5177 
5178 /**
5179  * enum nl80211_if_combination_attrs -- interface combination attributes
5180  *
5181  * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_UNSPEC: (reserved)
5182  * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_LIMITS: Nested attributes containing the limits
5183  *	for given interface types, see &enum nl80211_iface_limit_attrs.
5184  * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_MAXNUM: u32 attribute giving the total number of
5185  *	interfaces that can be created in this group. This number doesn't
5186  *	apply to interfaces purely managed in software, which are listed
5187  *	in a separate attribute %NL80211_ATTR_INTERFACES_SOFTWARE.
5188  * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_STA_AP_BI_MATCH: flag attribute specifying that
5189  *	beacon intervals within this group must be all the same even for
5190  *	infrastructure and AP/GO combinations, i.e. the GO(s) must adopt
5191  *	the infrastructure network's beacon interval.
5192  * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_NUM_CHANNELS: u32 attribute specifying how many
5193  *	different channels may be used within this group.
5194  * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_RADAR_DETECT_WIDTHS: u32 attribute containing the bitmap
5195  *	of supported channel widths for radar detection.
5196  * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_RADAR_DETECT_REGIONS: u32 attribute containing the bitmap
5197  *	of supported regulatory regions for radar detection.
5198  * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_BI_MIN_GCD: u32 attribute specifying the minimum GCD of
5199  *	different beacon intervals supported by all the interface combinations
5200  *	in this group (if not present, all beacon intervals be identical).
5201  * @NUM_NL80211_IFACE_COMB: number of attributes
5202  * @MAX_NL80211_IFACE_COMB: highest attribute number
5203  *
5204  * Examples:
5205  *	limits = [ #{STA} <= 1, #{AP} <= 1 ], matching BI, channels = 1, max = 2
5206  *	=> allows an AP and a STA that must match BIs
5207  *
5208  *	numbers = [ #{AP, P2P-GO} <= 8 ], BI min gcd, channels = 1, max = 8,
5209  *	=> allows 8 of AP/GO that can have BI gcd >= min gcd
5210  *
5211  *	numbers = [ #{STA} <= 2 ], channels = 2, max = 2
5212  *	=> allows two STAs on different channels
5213  *
5214  *	numbers = [ #{STA} <= 1, #{P2P-client,P2P-GO} <= 3 ], max = 4
5215  *	=> allows a STA plus three P2P interfaces
5216  *
5217  * The list of these four possibilities could completely be contained
5218  * within the %NL80211_ATTR_INTERFACE_COMBINATIONS attribute to indicate
5219  * that any of these groups must match.
5220  *
5221  * "Combinations" of just a single interface will not be listed here,
5222  * a single interface of any valid interface type is assumed to always
5223  * be possible by itself. This means that implicitly, for each valid
5224  * interface type, the following group always exists:
5225  *	numbers = [ #{<type>} <= 1 ], channels = 1, max = 1
5226  */
5227 enum nl80211_if_combination_attrs {
5228 	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_UNSPEC,
5229 	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_LIMITS,
5230 	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_MAXNUM,
5231 	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_STA_AP_BI_MATCH,
5232 	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_NUM_CHANNELS,
5233 	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_RADAR_DETECT_WIDTHS,
5234 	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_RADAR_DETECT_REGIONS,
5235 	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_BI_MIN_GCD,
5236 
5237 	/* keep last */
5238 	NUM_NL80211_IFACE_COMB,
5239 	MAX_NL80211_IFACE_COMB = NUM_NL80211_IFACE_COMB - 1
5240 };
5241 
5242 
5243 /**
5244  * enum nl80211_plink_state - state of a mesh peer link finite state machine
5245  *
5246  * @NL80211_PLINK_LISTEN: initial state, considered the implicit
5247  *	state of non existent mesh peer links
5248  * @NL80211_PLINK_OPN_SNT: mesh plink open frame has been sent to
5249  *	this mesh peer
5250  * @NL80211_PLINK_OPN_RCVD: mesh plink open frame has been received
5251  *	from this mesh peer
5252  * @NL80211_PLINK_CNF_RCVD: mesh plink confirm frame has been
5253  *	received from this mesh peer
5254  * @NL80211_PLINK_ESTAB: mesh peer link is established
5255  * @NL80211_PLINK_HOLDING: mesh peer link is being closed or cancelled
5256  * @NL80211_PLINK_BLOCKED: all frames transmitted from this mesh
5257  *	plink are discarded
5258  * @NUM_NL80211_PLINK_STATES: number of peer link states
5259  * @MAX_NL80211_PLINK_STATES: highest numerical value of plink states
5260  */
5261 enum nl80211_plink_state {
5262 	NL80211_PLINK_LISTEN,
5263 	NL80211_PLINK_OPN_SNT,
5264 	NL80211_PLINK_OPN_RCVD,
5265 	NL80211_PLINK_CNF_RCVD,
5266 	NL80211_PLINK_ESTAB,
5267 	NL80211_PLINK_HOLDING,
5268 	NL80211_PLINK_BLOCKED,
5269 
5270 	/* keep last */
5271 	NUM_NL80211_PLINK_STATES,
5272 	MAX_NL80211_PLINK_STATES = NUM_NL80211_PLINK_STATES - 1
5273 };
5274 
5275 /**
5276  * enum nl80211_plink_action - actions to perform in mesh peers
5277  *
5278  * @NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_NO_ACTION: perform no action
5279  * @NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_OPEN: start mesh peer link establishment
5280  * @NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_BLOCK: block traffic from this mesh peer
5281  * @NUM_NL80211_PLINK_ACTIONS: number of possible actions
5282  */
5283 enum plink_actions {
5284 	NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_NO_ACTION,
5285 	NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_OPEN,
5286 	NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_BLOCK,
5287 
5288 	NUM_NL80211_PLINK_ACTIONS,
5289 };
5290 
5291 
5292 #define NL80211_KCK_LEN			16
5293 #define NL80211_KEK_LEN			16
5294 #define NL80211_REPLAY_CTR_LEN		8
5295 
5296 /**
5297  * enum nl80211_rekey_data - attributes for GTK rekey offload
5298  * @__NL80211_REKEY_DATA_INVALID: invalid number for nested attributes
5299  * @NL80211_REKEY_DATA_KEK: key encryption key (binary)
5300  * @NL80211_REKEY_DATA_KCK: key confirmation key (binary)
5301  * @NL80211_REKEY_DATA_REPLAY_CTR: replay counter (binary)
5302  * @NUM_NL80211_REKEY_DATA: number of rekey attributes (internal)
5303  * @MAX_NL80211_REKEY_DATA: highest rekey attribute (internal)
5304  */
5305 enum nl80211_rekey_data {
5306 	__NL80211_REKEY_DATA_INVALID,
5307 	NL80211_REKEY_DATA_KEK,
5308 	NL80211_REKEY_DATA_KCK,
5309 	NL80211_REKEY_DATA_REPLAY_CTR,
5310 
5311 	/* keep last */
5312 	NUM_NL80211_REKEY_DATA,
5313 	MAX_NL80211_REKEY_DATA = NUM_NL80211_REKEY_DATA - 1
5314 };
5315 
5316 /**
5317  * enum nl80211_hidden_ssid - values for %NL80211_ATTR_HIDDEN_SSID
5318  * @NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_NOT_IN_USE: do not hide SSID (i.e., broadcast it in
5319  *	Beacon frames)
5320  * @NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_ZERO_LEN: hide SSID by using zero-length SSID element
5321  *	in Beacon frames
5322  * @NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_ZERO_CONTENTS: hide SSID by using correct length of SSID
5323  *	element in Beacon frames but zero out each byte in the SSID
5324  */
5325 enum nl80211_hidden_ssid {
5326 	NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_NOT_IN_USE,
5327 	NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_ZERO_LEN,
5328 	NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_ZERO_CONTENTS
5329 };
5330 
5331 /**
5332  * enum nl80211_sta_wme_attr - station WME attributes
5333  * @__NL80211_STA_WME_INVALID: invalid number for nested attribute
5334  * @NL80211_STA_WME_UAPSD_QUEUES: bitmap of uapsd queues. the format
5335  *	is the same as the AC bitmap in the QoS info field.
5336  * @NL80211_STA_WME_MAX_SP: max service period. the format is the same
5337  *	as the MAX_SP field in the QoS info field (but already shifted down).
5338  * @__NL80211_STA_WME_AFTER_LAST: internal
5339  * @NL80211_STA_WME_MAX: highest station WME attribute
5340  */
5341 enum nl80211_sta_wme_attr {
5342 	__NL80211_STA_WME_INVALID,
5343 	NL80211_STA_WME_UAPSD_QUEUES,
5344 	NL80211_STA_WME_MAX_SP,
5345 
5346 	/* keep last */
5347 	__NL80211_STA_WME_AFTER_LAST,
5348 	NL80211_STA_WME_MAX = __NL80211_STA_WME_AFTER_LAST - 1
5349 };
5350 
5351 /**
5352  * enum nl80211_pmksa_candidate_attr - attributes for PMKSA caching candidates
5353  * @__NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_INVALID: invalid number for nested attributes
5354  * @NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_INDEX: candidate index (u32; the smaller, the higher
5355  *	priority)
5356  * @NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_BSSID: candidate BSSID (6 octets)
5357  * @NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_PREAUTH: RSN pre-authentication supported (flag)
5358  * @NUM_NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE: number of PMKSA caching candidate attributes
5359  *	(internal)
5360  * @MAX_NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE: highest PMKSA caching candidate attribute
5361  *	(internal)
5362  */
5363 enum nl80211_pmksa_candidate_attr {
5364 	__NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_INVALID,
5365 	NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_INDEX,
5366 	NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_BSSID,
5367 	NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_PREAUTH,
5368 
5369 	/* keep last */
5370 	NUM_NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE,
5371 	MAX_NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE = NUM_NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE - 1
5372 };
5373 
5374 /**
5375  * enum nl80211_tdls_operation - values for %NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_OPERATION
5376  * @NL80211_TDLS_DISCOVERY_REQ: Send a TDLS discovery request
5377  * @NL80211_TDLS_SETUP: Setup TDLS link
5378  * @NL80211_TDLS_TEARDOWN: Teardown a TDLS link which is already established
5379  * @NL80211_TDLS_ENABLE_LINK: Enable TDLS link
5380  * @NL80211_TDLS_DISABLE_LINK: Disable TDLS link
5381  */
5382 enum nl80211_tdls_operation {
5383 	NL80211_TDLS_DISCOVERY_REQ,
5384 	NL80211_TDLS_SETUP,
5385 	NL80211_TDLS_TEARDOWN,
5386 	NL80211_TDLS_ENABLE_LINK,
5387 	NL80211_TDLS_DISABLE_LINK,
5388 };
5389 
5390 /*
5391  * enum nl80211_ap_sme_features - device-integrated AP features
5392  * Reserved for future use, no bits are defined in
5393  * NL80211_ATTR_DEVICE_AP_SME yet.
5394 enum nl80211_ap_sme_features {
5395 };
5396  */
5397 
5398 /**
5399  * enum nl80211_feature_flags - device/driver features
5400  * @NL80211_FEATURE_SK_TX_STATUS: This driver supports reflecting back
5401  *	TX status to the socket error queue when requested with the
5402  *	socket option.
5403  * @NL80211_FEATURE_HT_IBSS: This driver supports IBSS with HT datarates.
5404  * @NL80211_FEATURE_INACTIVITY_TIMER: This driver takes care of freeing up
5405  *	the connected inactive stations in AP mode.
5406  * @NL80211_FEATURE_CELL_BASE_REG_HINTS: This driver has been tested
5407  *	to work properly to suppport receiving regulatory hints from
5408  *	cellular base stations.
5409  * @NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_DEVICE_NEEDS_CHANNEL: (no longer available, only
5410  *	here to reserve the value for API/ABI compatibility)
5411  * @NL80211_FEATURE_SAE: This driver supports simultaneous authentication of
5412  *	equals (SAE) with user space SME (NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE) in station
5413  *	mode
5414  * @NL80211_FEATURE_LOW_PRIORITY_SCAN: This driver supports low priority scan
5415  * @NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_FLUSH: Scan flush is supported
5416  * @NL80211_FEATURE_AP_SCAN: Support scanning using an AP vif
5417  * @NL80211_FEATURE_VIF_TXPOWER: The driver supports per-vif TX power setting
5418  * @NL80211_FEATURE_NEED_OBSS_SCAN: The driver expects userspace to perform
5419  *	OBSS scans and generate 20/40 BSS coex reports. This flag is used only
5420  *	for drivers implementing the CONNECT API, for AUTH/ASSOC it is implied.
5421  * @NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_GO_CTWIN: P2P GO implementation supports CT Window
5422  *	setting
5423  * @NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_GO_OPPPS: P2P GO implementation supports opportunistic
5424  *	powersave
5425  * @NL80211_FEATURE_FULL_AP_CLIENT_STATE: The driver supports full state
5426  *	transitions for AP clients. Without this flag (and if the driver
5427  *	doesn't have the AP SME in the device) the driver supports adding
5428  *	stations only when they're associated and adds them in associated
5429  *	state (to later be transitioned into authorized), with this flag
5430  *	they should be added before even sending the authentication reply
5431  *	and then transitioned into authenticated, associated and authorized
5432  *	states using station flags.
5433  *	Note that even for drivers that support this, the default is to add
5434  *	stations in authenticated/associated state, so to add unauthenticated
5435  *	stations the authenticated/associated bits have to be set in the mask.
5436  * @NL80211_FEATURE_ADVERTISE_CHAN_LIMITS: cfg80211 advertises channel limits
5437  *	(HT40, VHT 80/160 MHz) if this flag is set
5438  * @NL80211_FEATURE_USERSPACE_MPM: This driver supports a userspace Mesh
5439  *	Peering Management entity which may be implemented by registering for
5440  *	beacons or NL80211_CMD_NEW_PEER_CANDIDATE events. The mesh beacon is
5441  *	still generated by the driver.
5442  * @NL80211_FEATURE_ACTIVE_MONITOR: This driver supports an active monitor
5443  *	interface. An active monitor interface behaves like a normal monitor
5444  *	interface, but gets added to the driver. It ensures that incoming
5445  *	unicast packets directed at the configured interface address get ACKed.
5446  * @NL80211_FEATURE_AP_MODE_CHAN_WIDTH_CHANGE: This driver supports dynamic
5447  *	channel bandwidth change (e.g., HT 20 <-> 40 MHz channel) during the
5448  *	lifetime of a BSS.
5449  * @NL80211_FEATURE_DS_PARAM_SET_IE_IN_PROBES: This device adds a DS Parameter
5450  *	Set IE to probe requests.
5451  * @NL80211_FEATURE_WFA_TPC_IE_IN_PROBES: This device adds a WFA TPC Report IE
5452  *	to probe requests.
5453  * @NL80211_FEATURE_QUIET: This device, in client mode, supports Quiet Period
5454  *	requests sent to it by an AP.
5455  * @NL80211_FEATURE_TX_POWER_INSERTION: This device is capable of inserting the
5456  *	current tx power value into the TPC Report IE in the spectrum
5457  *	management TPC Report action frame, and in the Radio Measurement Link
5458  *	Measurement Report action frame.
5459  * @NL80211_FEATURE_ACKTO_ESTIMATION: This driver supports dynamic ACK timeout
5460  *	estimation (dynack). %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_DYN_ACK flag attribute is used
5461  *	to enable dynack.
5462  * @NL80211_FEATURE_STATIC_SMPS: Device supports static spatial
5463  *	multiplexing powersave, ie. can turn off all but one chain
5464  *	even on HT connections that should be using more chains.
5465  * @NL80211_FEATURE_DYNAMIC_SMPS: Device supports dynamic spatial
5466  *	multiplexing powersave, ie. can turn off all but one chain
5467  *	and then wake the rest up as required after, for example,
5468  *	rts/cts handshake.
5469  * @NL80211_FEATURE_SUPPORTS_WMM_ADMISSION: the device supports setting up WMM
5470  *	TSPEC sessions (TID aka TSID 0-7) with the %NL80211_CMD_ADD_TX_TS
5471  *	command. Standard IEEE 802.11 TSPEC setup is not yet supported, it
5472  *	needs to be able to handle Block-Ack agreements and other things.
5473  * @NL80211_FEATURE_MAC_ON_CREATE: Device supports configuring
5474  *	the vif's MAC address upon creation.
5475  *	See 'macaddr' field in the vif_params (cfg80211.h).
5476  * @NL80211_FEATURE_TDLS_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Driver supports channel switching when
5477  *	operating as a TDLS peer.
5478  * @NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR: This device/driver supports using a
5479  *	random MAC address during scan (if the device is unassociated); the
5480  *	%NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR flag may be set for scans and the MAC
5481  *	address mask/value will be used.
5482  * @NL80211_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR: This device/driver supports
5483  *	using a random MAC address for every scan iteration during scheduled
5484  *	scan (while not associated), the %NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR may
5485  *	be set for scheduled scan and the MAC address mask/value will be used.
5486  * @NL80211_FEATURE_ND_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR: This device/driver supports using a
5487  *	random MAC address for every scan iteration during "net detect", i.e.
5488  *	scan in unassociated WoWLAN, the %NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR may
5489  *	be set for scheduled scan and the MAC address mask/value will be used.
5490  */
5491 enum nl80211_feature_flags {
5492 	NL80211_FEATURE_SK_TX_STATUS			= 1 << 0,
5493 	NL80211_FEATURE_HT_IBSS				= 1 << 1,
5494 	NL80211_FEATURE_INACTIVITY_TIMER		= 1 << 2,
5495 	NL80211_FEATURE_CELL_BASE_REG_HINTS		= 1 << 3,
5496 	NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_DEVICE_NEEDS_CHANNEL	= 1 << 4,
5497 	NL80211_FEATURE_SAE				= 1 << 5,
5498 	NL80211_FEATURE_LOW_PRIORITY_SCAN		= 1 << 6,
5499 	NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_FLUSH			= 1 << 7,
5500 	NL80211_FEATURE_AP_SCAN				= 1 << 8,
5501 	NL80211_FEATURE_VIF_TXPOWER			= 1 << 9,
5502 	NL80211_FEATURE_NEED_OBSS_SCAN			= 1 << 10,
5503 	NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_GO_CTWIN			= 1 << 11,
5504 	NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_GO_OPPPS			= 1 << 12,
5505 	/* bit 13 is reserved */
5506 	NL80211_FEATURE_ADVERTISE_CHAN_LIMITS		= 1 << 14,
5507 	NL80211_FEATURE_FULL_AP_CLIENT_STATE		= 1 << 15,
5508 	NL80211_FEATURE_USERSPACE_MPM			= 1 << 16,
5509 	NL80211_FEATURE_ACTIVE_MONITOR			= 1 << 17,
5510 	NL80211_FEATURE_AP_MODE_CHAN_WIDTH_CHANGE	= 1 << 18,
5511 	NL80211_FEATURE_DS_PARAM_SET_IE_IN_PROBES	= 1 << 19,
5512 	NL80211_FEATURE_WFA_TPC_IE_IN_PROBES		= 1 << 20,
5513 	NL80211_FEATURE_QUIET				= 1 << 21,
5514 	NL80211_FEATURE_TX_POWER_INSERTION		= 1 << 22,
5515 	NL80211_FEATURE_ACKTO_ESTIMATION		= 1 << 23,
5516 	NL80211_FEATURE_STATIC_SMPS			= 1 << 24,
5517 	NL80211_FEATURE_DYNAMIC_SMPS			= 1 << 25,
5518 	NL80211_FEATURE_SUPPORTS_WMM_ADMISSION		= 1 << 26,
5519 	NL80211_FEATURE_MAC_ON_CREATE			= 1 << 27,
5520 	NL80211_FEATURE_TDLS_CHANNEL_SWITCH		= 1 << 28,
5521 	NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR		= 1 << 29,
5522 	NL80211_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR	= 1 << 30,
5523 	NL80211_FEATURE_ND_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR		= 1U << 31,
5524 };
5525 
5526 /**
5527  * enum nl80211_ext_feature_index - bit index of extended features.
5528  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_VHT_IBSS: This driver supports IBSS with VHT datarates.
5529  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_RRM: This driver supports RRM. When featured, user can
5530  *	can request to use RRM (see %NL80211_ATTR_USE_RRM) with
5531  *	%NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE and %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT requests, which will set
5532  *	the ASSOC_REQ_USE_RRM flag in the association request even if
5533  *	NL80211_FEATURE_QUIET is not advertized.
5534  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MU_MIMO_AIR_SNIFFER: This device supports MU-MIMO air
5535  *	sniffer which means that it can be configured to hear packets from
5536  *	certain groups which can be configured by the
5537  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_GROUP_DATA attribute,
5538  *	or can be configured to follow a station by configuring the
5539  *	%NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_FOLLOW_MAC_ADDR attribute.
5540  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_START_TIME: This driver includes the actual
5541  *	time the scan started in scan results event. The time is the TSF of
5542  *	the BSS that the interface that requested the scan is connected to
5543  *	(if available).
5544  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BSS_PARENT_TSF: Per BSS, this driver reports the
5545  *	time the last beacon/probe was received. The time is the TSF of the
5546  *	BSS that the interface that requested the scan is connected to
5547  *	(if available).
5548  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SET_SCAN_DWELL: This driver supports configuration of
5549  *	channel dwell time.
5550  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_LEGACY: Driver supports beacon rate
5551  *	configuration (AP/mesh), supporting a legacy (non HT/VHT) rate.
5552  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HT: Driver supports beacon rate
5553  *	configuration (AP/mesh) with HT rates.
5554  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_VHT: Driver supports beacon rate
5555  *	configuration (AP/mesh) with VHT rates.
5556  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_STA: This driver supports Fast Initial Link Setup
5557  *	with user space SME (NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE) in station mode.
5558  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MGMT_TX_RANDOM_TA: This driver supports randomized TA
5559  *	in @NL80211_CMD_FRAME while not associated.
5560  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MGMT_TX_RANDOM_TA_CONNECTED: This driver supports
5561  *	randomized TA in @NL80211_CMD_FRAME while associated.
5562  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI: The driver supports sched_scan
5563  *	for reporting BSSs with better RSSI than the current connected BSS
5564  *	(%NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI).
5565  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CQM_RSSI_LIST: With this driver the
5566  *	%NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_THOLD attribute accepts a list of zero or more
5567  *	RSSI threshold values to monitor rather than exactly one threshold.
5568  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_SK_OFFLOAD: Driver SME supports FILS shared key
5569  *	authentication with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT.
5570  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_PSK: Device wants to do 4-way
5571  *	handshake with PSK in station mode (PSK is passed as part of the connect
5572  *	and associate commands), doing it in the host might not be supported.
5573  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_1X: Device wants to do doing 4-way
5574  *	handshake with 802.1X in station mode (will pass EAP frames to the host
5575  *	and accept the set_pmk/del_pmk commands), doing it in the host might not
5576  *	be supported.
5577  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_MAX_CHANNEL_TIME: Driver is capable of overriding
5578  *	the max channel attribute in the FILS request params IE with the
5579  *	actual dwell time.
5580  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ACCEPT_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: Driver accepts broadcast probe
5581  *	response
5582  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OCE_PROBE_REQ_HIGH_TX_RATE: Driver supports sending
5583  *	the first probe request in each channel at rate of at least 5.5Mbps.
5584  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OCE_PROBE_REQ_DEFERRAL_SUPPRESSION: Driver supports
5585  *	probe request tx deferral and suppression
5586  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MFP_OPTIONAL: Driver supports the %NL80211_MFP_OPTIONAL
5587  *	value in %NL80211_ATTR_USE_MFP.
5588  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_LOW_SPAN_SCAN: Driver supports low span scan.
5589  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_LOW_POWER_SCAN: Driver supports low power scan.
5590  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_HIGH_ACCURACY_SCAN: Driver supports high accuracy scan.
5591  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DFS_OFFLOAD: HW/driver will offload DFS actions.
5592  *	Device or driver will do all DFS-related actions by itself,
5593  *	informing user-space about CAC progress, radar detection event,
5594  *	channel change triggered by radar detection event.
5595  *	No need to start CAC from user-space, no need to react to
5596  *	"radar detected" event.
5597  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211: Driver supports sending and
5598  *	receiving control port frames over nl80211 instead of the netdevice.
5599  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ACK_SIGNAL_SUPPORT: This driver/device supports
5600  *	(average) ACK signal strength reporting.
5601  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_TXQS: Driver supports FQ-CoDel-enabled intermediate
5602  *      TXQs.
5603  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_SN: Driver/device supports randomizing the
5604  *	SN in probe request frames if requested by %NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_SN.
5605  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_MIN_PREQ_CONTENT: Driver/device can omit all data
5606  *	except for supported rates from the probe request content if requested
5607  *	by the %NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_MIN_PREQ_CONTENT flag.
5608  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ENABLE_FTM_RESPONDER: Driver supports enabling fine
5609  *	timing measurement responder role.
5610  *
5611  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CAN_REPLACE_PTK0: Driver/device confirm that they are
5612  *      able to rekey an in-use key correctly. Userspace must not rekey PTK keys
5613  *      if this flag is not set. Ignoring this can leak clear text packets and/or
5614  *      freeze the connection.
5615  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_EXT_KEY_ID: Driver supports "Extended Key ID for
5616  *      Individually Addressed Frames" from IEEE802.11-2016.
5617  *
5618  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AIRTIME_FAIRNESS: Driver supports getting airtime
5619  *	fairness for transmitted packets and has enabled airtime fairness
5620  *	scheduling.
5621  *
5622  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AP_PMKSA_CACHING: Driver/device supports PMKSA caching
5623  *	(set/del PMKSA operations) in AP mode.
5624  *
5625  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_BAND_SPECIFIC_RSSI_THOLD: Driver supports
5626  *	filtering of sched scan results using band specific RSSI thresholds.
5627  *
5628  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_STA_TX_PWR: This driver supports controlling tx power
5629  *	to a station.
5630  *
5631  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SAE_OFFLOAD: Device wants to do SAE authentication in
5632  *	station mode (SAE password is passed as part of the connect command).
5633  *
5634  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_VLAN_OFFLOAD: The driver supports a single netdev
5635  *	with VLAN tagged frames and separate VLAN-specific netdevs added using
5636  *	vconfig similarly to the Ethernet case.
5637  *
5638  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AQL: The driver supports the Airtime Queue Limit (AQL)
5639  *	feature, which prevents bufferbloat by using the expected transmission
5640  *	time to limit the amount of data buffered in the hardware.
5641  *
5642  * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_PROTECTION: The driver supports Beacon protection
5643  *	and can receive key configuration for BIGTK using key indexes 6 and 7.
5644  *
5645  * @NUM_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES: number of extended features.
5646  * @MAX_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES: highest extended feature index.
5647  */
5648 enum nl80211_ext_feature_index {
5649 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_VHT_IBSS,
5650 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_RRM,
5651 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MU_MIMO_AIR_SNIFFER,
5652 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_START_TIME,
5653 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BSS_PARENT_TSF,
5654 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SET_SCAN_DWELL,
5655 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_LEGACY,
5656 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HT,
5657 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_VHT,
5658 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_STA,
5659 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MGMT_TX_RANDOM_TA,
5660 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MGMT_TX_RANDOM_TA_CONNECTED,
5661 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI,
5662 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CQM_RSSI_LIST,
5663 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_SK_OFFLOAD,
5664 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_PSK,
5665 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_1X,
5666 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_MAX_CHANNEL_TIME,
5667 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ACCEPT_BCAST_PROBE_RESP,
5668 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OCE_PROBE_REQ_HIGH_TX_RATE,
5669 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OCE_PROBE_REQ_DEFERRAL_SUPPRESSION,
5670 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MFP_OPTIONAL,
5671 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_LOW_SPAN_SCAN,
5672 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_LOW_POWER_SCAN,
5673 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_HIGH_ACCURACY_SCAN,
5674 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DFS_OFFLOAD,
5675 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211,
5676 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ACK_SIGNAL_SUPPORT,
5677 	/* we renamed this - stay compatible */
5678 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DATA_ACK_SIGNAL_SUPPORT = NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ACK_SIGNAL_SUPPORT,
5679 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_TXQS,
5680 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_SN,
5681 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_MIN_PREQ_CONTENT,
5682 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CAN_REPLACE_PTK0,
5683 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ENABLE_FTM_RESPONDER,
5684 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AIRTIME_FAIRNESS,
5685 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AP_PMKSA_CACHING,
5686 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_BAND_SPECIFIC_RSSI_THOLD,
5687 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_EXT_KEY_ID,
5688 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_STA_TX_PWR,
5689 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SAE_OFFLOAD,
5690 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_VLAN_OFFLOAD,
5691 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AQL,
5692 	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_PROTECTION,
5693 
5694 	/* add new features before the definition below */
5695 	NUM_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES,
5696 	MAX_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES = NUM_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES - 1
5697 };
5698 
5699 /**
5700  * enum nl80211_probe_resp_offload_support_attr - optional supported
5701  *	protocols for probe-response offloading by the driver/FW.
5702  *	To be used with the %NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD attribute.
5703  *	Each enum value represents a bit in the bitmap of supported
5704  *	protocols. Typically a subset of probe-requests belonging to a
5705  *	supported protocol will be excluded from offload and uploaded
5706  *	to the host.
5707  *
5708  * @NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_WPS: Support for WPS ver. 1
5709  * @NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_WPS2: Support for WPS ver. 2
5710  * @NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_P2P: Support for P2P
5711  * @NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_80211U: Support for 802.11u
5712  */
5713 enum nl80211_probe_resp_offload_support_attr {
5714 	NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_WPS =	1<<0,
5715 	NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_WPS2 =	1<<1,
5716 	NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_P2P =	1<<2,
5717 	NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_80211U =	1<<3,
5718 };
5719 
5720 /**
5721  * enum nl80211_connect_failed_reason - connection request failed reasons
5722  * @NL80211_CONN_FAIL_MAX_CLIENTS: Maximum number of clients that can be
5723  *	handled by the AP is reached.
5724  * @NL80211_CONN_FAIL_BLOCKED_CLIENT: Connection request is rejected due to ACL.
5725  */
5726 enum nl80211_connect_failed_reason {
5727 	NL80211_CONN_FAIL_MAX_CLIENTS,
5728 	NL80211_CONN_FAIL_BLOCKED_CLIENT,
5729 };
5730 
5731 /**
5732  * enum nl80211_timeout_reason - timeout reasons
5733  *
5734  * @NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED: Timeout reason unspecified.
5735  * @NL80211_TIMEOUT_SCAN: Scan (AP discovery) timed out.
5736  * @NL80211_TIMEOUT_AUTH: Authentication timed out.
5737  * @NL80211_TIMEOUT_ASSOC: Association timed out.
5738  */
5739 enum nl80211_timeout_reason {
5740 	NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED,
5741 	NL80211_TIMEOUT_SCAN,
5742 	NL80211_TIMEOUT_AUTH,
5743 	NL80211_TIMEOUT_ASSOC,
5744 };
5745 
5746 /**
5747  * enum nl80211_scan_flags -  scan request control flags
5748  *
5749  * Scan request control flags are used to control the handling
5750  * of NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN and NL80211_CMD_START_SCHED_SCAN
5751  * requests.
5752  *
5753  * NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_SPAN, NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_POWER, and
5754  * NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_HIGH_ACCURACY flags are exclusive of each other, i.e., only
5755  * one of them can be used in the request.
5756  *
5757  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_PRIORITY: scan request has low priority
5758  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FLUSH: flush cache before scanning
5759  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_AP: force a scan even if the interface is configured
5760  *	as AP and the beaconing has already been configured. This attribute is
5761  *	dangerous because will destroy stations performance as a lot of frames
5762  *	will be lost while scanning off-channel, therefore it must be used only
5763  *	when really needed
5764  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR: use a random MAC address for this scan (or
5765  *	for scheduled scan: a different one for every scan iteration). When the
5766  *	flag is set, depending on device capabilities the @NL80211_ATTR_MAC and
5767  *	@NL80211_ATTR_MAC_MASK attributes may also be given in which case only
5768  *	the masked bits will be preserved from the MAC address and the remainder
5769  *	randomised. If the attributes are not given full randomisation (46 bits,
5770  *	locally administered 1, multicast 0) is assumed.
5771  *	This flag must not be requested when the feature isn't supported, check
5772  *	the nl80211 feature flags for the device.
5773  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FILS_MAX_CHANNEL_TIME: fill the dwell time in the FILS
5774  *	request parameters IE in the probe request
5775  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_ACCEPT_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: accept broadcast probe responses
5776  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_OCE_PROBE_REQ_HIGH_TX_RATE: send probe request frames at
5777  *	rate of at least 5.5M. In case non OCE AP is discovered in the channel,
5778  *	only the first probe req in the channel will be sent in high rate.
5779  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_OCE_PROBE_REQ_DEFERRAL_SUPPRESSION: allow probe request
5780  *	tx deferral (dot11FILSProbeDelay shall be set to 15ms)
5781  *	and suppression (if it has received a broadcast Probe Response frame,
5782  *	Beacon frame or FILS Discovery frame from an AP that the STA considers
5783  *	a suitable candidate for (re-)association - suitable in terms of
5784  *	SSID and/or RSSI.
5785  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_SPAN: Span corresponds to the total time taken to
5786  *	accomplish the scan. Thus, this flag intends the driver to perform the
5787  *	scan request with lesser span/duration. It is specific to the driver
5788  *	implementations on how this is accomplished. Scan accuracy may get
5789  *	impacted with this flag.
5790  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_POWER: This flag intends the scan attempts to consume
5791  *	optimal possible power. Drivers can resort to their specific means to
5792  *	optimize the power. Scan accuracy may get impacted with this flag.
5793  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_HIGH_ACCURACY: Accuracy here intends to the extent of scan
5794  *	results obtained. Thus HIGH_ACCURACY scan flag aims to get maximum
5795  *	possible scan results. This flag hints the driver to use the best
5796  *	possible scan configuration to improve the accuracy in scanning.
5797  *	Latency and power use may get impacted with this flag.
5798  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_SN: randomize the sequence number in probe
5799  *	request frames from this scan to avoid correlation/tracking being
5800  *	possible.
5801  * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_MIN_PREQ_CONTENT: minimize probe request content to
5802  *	only have supported rates and no additional capabilities (unless
5803  *	added by userspace explicitly.)
5804  */
5805 enum nl80211_scan_flags {
5806 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_PRIORITY				= 1<<0,
5807 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FLUSH					= 1<<1,
5808 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_AP					= 1<<2,
5809 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR				= 1<<3,
5810 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FILS_MAX_CHANNEL_TIME			= 1<<4,
5811 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_ACCEPT_BCAST_PROBE_RESP		= 1<<5,
5812 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_OCE_PROBE_REQ_HIGH_TX_RATE		= 1<<6,
5813 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_OCE_PROBE_REQ_DEFERRAL_SUPPRESSION	= 1<<7,
5814 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_SPAN				= 1<<8,
5815 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_POWER				= 1<<9,
5816 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_HIGH_ACCURACY				= 1<<10,
5817 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_SN				= 1<<11,
5818 	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_MIN_PREQ_CONTENT			= 1<<12,
5819 };
5820 
5821 /**
5822  * enum nl80211_acl_policy - access control policy
5823  *
5824  * Access control policy is applied on a MAC list set by
5825  * %NL80211_CMD_START_AP and %NL80211_CMD_SET_MAC_ACL, to
5826  * be used with %NL80211_ATTR_ACL_POLICY.
5827  *
5828  * @NL80211_ACL_POLICY_ACCEPT_UNLESS_LISTED: Deny stations which are
5829  *	listed in ACL, i.e. allow all the stations which are not listed
5830  *	in ACL to authenticate.
5831  * @NL80211_ACL_POLICY_DENY_UNLESS_LISTED: Allow the stations which are listed
5832  *	in ACL, i.e. deny all the stations which are not listed in ACL.
5833  */
5834 enum nl80211_acl_policy {
5835 	NL80211_ACL_POLICY_ACCEPT_UNLESS_LISTED,
5836 	NL80211_ACL_POLICY_DENY_UNLESS_LISTED,
5837 };
5838 
5839 /**
5840  * enum nl80211_smps_mode - SMPS mode
5841  *
5842  * Requested SMPS mode (for AP mode)
5843  *
5844  * @NL80211_SMPS_OFF: SMPS off (use all antennas).
5845  * @NL80211_SMPS_STATIC: static SMPS (use a single antenna)
5846  * @NL80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC: dynamic smps (start with a single antenna and
5847  *	turn on other antennas after CTS/RTS).
5848  */
5849 enum nl80211_smps_mode {
5850 	NL80211_SMPS_OFF,
5851 	NL80211_SMPS_STATIC,
5852 	NL80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC,
5853 
5854 	__NL80211_SMPS_AFTER_LAST,
5855 	NL80211_SMPS_MAX = __NL80211_SMPS_AFTER_LAST - 1
5856 };
5857 
5858 /**
5859  * enum nl80211_radar_event - type of radar event for DFS operation
5860  *
5861  * Type of event to be used with NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_EVENT to inform userspace
5862  * about detected radars or success of the channel available check (CAC)
5863  *
5864  * @NL80211_RADAR_DETECTED: A radar pattern has been detected. The channel is
5865  *	now unusable.
5866  * @NL80211_RADAR_CAC_FINISHED: Channel Availability Check has been finished,
5867  *	the channel is now available.
5868  * @NL80211_RADAR_CAC_ABORTED: Channel Availability Check has been aborted, no
5869  *	change to the channel status.
5870  * @NL80211_RADAR_NOP_FINISHED: The Non-Occupancy Period for this channel is
5871  *	over, channel becomes usable.
5872  * @NL80211_RADAR_PRE_CAC_EXPIRED: Channel Availability Check done on this
5873  *	non-operating channel is expired and no longer valid. New CAC must
5874  *	be done on this channel before starting the operation. This is not
5875  *	applicable for ETSI dfs domain where pre-CAC is valid for ever.
5876  * @NL80211_RADAR_CAC_STARTED: Channel Availability Check has been started,
5877  *	should be generated by HW if NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DFS_OFFLOAD is enabled.
5878  */
5879 enum nl80211_radar_event {
5880 	NL80211_RADAR_DETECTED,
5881 	NL80211_RADAR_CAC_FINISHED,
5882 	NL80211_RADAR_CAC_ABORTED,
5883 	NL80211_RADAR_NOP_FINISHED,
5884 	NL80211_RADAR_PRE_CAC_EXPIRED,
5885 	NL80211_RADAR_CAC_STARTED,
5886 };
5887 
5888 /**
5889  * enum nl80211_dfs_state - DFS states for channels
5890  *
5891  * Channel states used by the DFS code.
5892  *
5893  * @NL80211_DFS_USABLE: The channel can be used, but channel availability
5894  *	check (CAC) must be performed before using it for AP or IBSS.
5895  * @NL80211_DFS_UNAVAILABLE: A radar has been detected on this channel, it
5896  *	is therefore marked as not available.
5897  * @NL80211_DFS_AVAILABLE: The channel has been CAC checked and is available.
5898  */
5899 enum nl80211_dfs_state {
5900 	NL80211_DFS_USABLE,
5901 	NL80211_DFS_UNAVAILABLE,
5902 	NL80211_DFS_AVAILABLE,
5903 };
5904 
5905 /**
5906  * enum enum nl80211_protocol_features - nl80211 protocol features
5907  * @NL80211_PROTOCOL_FEATURE_SPLIT_WIPHY_DUMP: nl80211 supports splitting
5908  *	wiphy dumps (if requested by the application with the attribute
5909  *	%NL80211_ATTR_SPLIT_WIPHY_DUMP. Also supported is filtering the
5910  *	wiphy dump by %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY, %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX or
5911  *	%NL80211_ATTR_WDEV.
5912  */
5913 enum nl80211_protocol_features {
5914 	NL80211_PROTOCOL_FEATURE_SPLIT_WIPHY_DUMP =	1 << 0,
5915 };
5916 
5917 /**
5918  * enum nl80211_crit_proto_id - nl80211 critical protocol identifiers
5919  *
5920  * @NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_UNSPEC: protocol unspecified.
5921  * @NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_DHCP: BOOTP or DHCPv6 protocol.
5922  * @NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_EAPOL: EAPOL protocol.
5923  * @NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_APIPA: APIPA protocol.
5924  * @NUM_NL80211_CRIT_PROTO: must be kept last.
5925  */
5926 enum nl80211_crit_proto_id {
5927 	NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_UNSPEC,
5928 	NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_DHCP,
5929 	NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_EAPOL,
5930 	NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_APIPA,
5931 	/* add other protocols before this one */
5932 	NUM_NL80211_CRIT_PROTO
5933 };
5934 
5935 /* maximum duration for critical protocol measures */
5936 #define NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_MAX_DURATION		5000 /* msec */
5937 
5938 /**
5939  * enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags - flags for received management frame.
5940  *
5941  * Used by cfg80211_rx_mgmt()
5942  *
5943  * @NL80211_RXMGMT_FLAG_ANSWERED: frame was answered by device/driver.
5944  * @NL80211_RXMGMT_FLAG_EXTERNAL_AUTH: Host driver intends to offload
5945  *	the authentication. Exclusively defined for host drivers that
5946  *	advertises the SME functionality but would like the userspace
5947  *	to handle certain authentication algorithms (e.g. SAE).
5948  */
5949 enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags {
5950 	NL80211_RXMGMT_FLAG_ANSWERED = 1 << 0,
5951 	NL80211_RXMGMT_FLAG_EXTERNAL_AUTH = 1 << 1,
5952 };
5953 
5954 /*
5955  * If this flag is unset, the lower 24 bits are an OUI, if set
5956  * a Linux nl80211 vendor ID is used (no such IDs are allocated
5957  * yet, so that's not valid so far)
5958  */
5959 #define NL80211_VENDOR_ID_IS_LINUX	0x80000000
5960 
5961 /**
5962  * struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info - vendor command data
5963  * @vendor_id: If the %NL80211_VENDOR_ID_IS_LINUX flag is clear, then the
5964  *	value is a 24-bit OUI; if it is set then a separately allocated ID
5965  *	may be used, but no such IDs are allocated yet. New IDs should be
5966  *	added to this file when needed.
5967  * @subcmd: sub-command ID for the command
5968  */
5969 struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info {
5970 	__u32 vendor_id;
5971 	__u32 subcmd;
5972 };
5973 
5974 /**
5975  * enum nl80211_tdls_peer_capability - TDLS peer flags.
5976  *
5977  * Used by tdls_mgmt() to determine which conditional elements need
5978  * to be added to TDLS Setup frames.
5979  *
5980  * @NL80211_TDLS_PEER_HT: TDLS peer is HT capable.
5981  * @NL80211_TDLS_PEER_VHT: TDLS peer is VHT capable.
5982  * @NL80211_TDLS_PEER_WMM: TDLS peer is WMM capable.
5983  */
5984 enum nl80211_tdls_peer_capability {
5985 	NL80211_TDLS_PEER_HT = 1<<0,
5986 	NL80211_TDLS_PEER_VHT = 1<<1,
5987 	NL80211_TDLS_PEER_WMM = 1<<2,
5988 };
5989 
5990 /**
5991  * enum nl80211_sched_scan_plan - scanning plan for scheduled scan
5992  * @__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
5993  * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_INTERVAL: interval between scan iterations. In
5994  *	seconds (u32).
5995  * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_ITERATIONS: number of scan iterations in this
5996  *	scan plan (u32). The last scan plan must not specify this attribute
5997  *	because it will run infinitely. A value of zero is invalid as it will
5998  *	make the scan plan meaningless.
5999  * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_MAX: highest scheduled scan plan attribute number
6000  *	currently defined
6001  * @__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_AFTER_LAST: internal use
6002  */
6003 enum nl80211_sched_scan_plan {
6004 	__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_INVALID,
6005 	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_INTERVAL,
6006 	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_ITERATIONS,
6007 
6008 	/* keep last */
6009 	__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_AFTER_LAST,
6010 	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_MAX =
6011 		__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_AFTER_LAST - 1
6012 };
6013 
6014 /**
6015  * struct nl80211_bss_select_rssi_adjust - RSSI adjustment parameters.
6016  *
6017  * @band: band of BSS that must match for RSSI value adjustment. The value
6018  *	of this field is according to &enum nl80211_band.
6019  * @delta: value used to adjust the RSSI value of matching BSS in dB.
6020  */
6021 struct nl80211_bss_select_rssi_adjust {
6022 	__u8 band;
6023 	__s8 delta;
6024 } __attribute__((packed));
6025 
6026 /**
6027  * enum nl80211_bss_select_attr - attributes for bss selection.
6028  *
6029  * @__NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_INVALID: reserved.
6030  * @NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI: Flag indicating only RSSI-based BSS selection
6031  *	is requested.
6032  * @NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_BAND_PREF: attribute indicating BSS
6033  *	selection should be done such that the specified band is preferred.
6034  *	When there are multiple BSS-es in the preferred band, the driver
6035  *	shall use RSSI-based BSS selection as a second step. The value of
6036  *	this attribute is according to &enum nl80211_band (u32).
6037  * @NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST: When present the RSSI level for
6038  *	BSS-es in the specified band is to be adjusted before doing
6039  *	RSSI-based BSS selection. The attribute value is a packed structure
6040  *	value as specified by &struct nl80211_bss_select_rssi_adjust.
6041  * @NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_MAX: highest bss select attribute number.
6042  * @__NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use.
6043  *
6044  * One and only one of these attributes are found within %NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SELECT
6045  * for %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT. It specifies the required BSS selection behaviour
6046  * which the driver shall use.
6047  */
6048 enum nl80211_bss_select_attr {
6049 	__NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_INVALID,
6050 	NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI,
6051 	NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_BAND_PREF,
6052 	NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST,
6053 
6054 	/* keep last */
6055 	__NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
6056 	NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
6057 };
6058 
6059 /**
6060  * enum nl80211_nan_function_type - NAN function type
6061  *
6062  * Defines the function type of a NAN function
6063  *
6064  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH: function is publish
6065  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE: function is subscribe
6066  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP: function is follow-up
6067  */
6068 enum nl80211_nan_function_type {
6069 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH,
6070 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE,
6071 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP,
6072 
6073 	/* keep last */
6074 	__NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TYPE_AFTER_LAST,
6075 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_MAX_TYPE = __NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TYPE_AFTER_LAST - 1,
6076 };
6077 
6078 /**
6079  * enum nl80211_nan_publish_type - NAN publish tx type
6080  *
6081  * Defines how to send publish Service Discovery Frames
6082  *
6083  * @NL80211_NAN_SOLICITED_PUBLISH: publish function is solicited
6084  * @NL80211_NAN_UNSOLICITED_PUBLISH: publish function is unsolicited
6085  */
6086 enum nl80211_nan_publish_type {
6087 	NL80211_NAN_SOLICITED_PUBLISH = 1 << 0,
6088 	NL80211_NAN_UNSOLICITED_PUBLISH = 1 << 1,
6089 };
6090 
6091 /**
6092  * enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason - NAN functions termination reason
6093  *
6094  * Defines termination reasons of a NAN function
6095  *
6096  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_USER_REQUEST: requested by user
6097  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_TTL_EXPIRED: timeout
6098  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_ERROR: errored
6099  */
6100 enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason {
6101 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_USER_REQUEST,
6102 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_TTL_EXPIRED,
6103 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_ERROR,
6104 };
6105 
6106 #define NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_ID_LEN 6
6107 #define NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_SPEC_INFO_MAX_LEN 0xff
6108 #define NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SRF_MAX_LEN 0xff
6109 
6110 /**
6111  * enum nl80211_nan_func_attributes - NAN function attributes
6112  * @__NL80211_NAN_FUNC_INVALID: invalid
6113  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TYPE: &enum nl80211_nan_function_type (u8).
6114  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_ID: 6 bytes of the service ID hash as
6115  *	specified in NAN spec. This is a binary attribute.
6116  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH_TYPE: relevant if the function's type is
6117  *	publish. Defines the transmission type for the publish Service Discovery
6118  *	Frame, see &enum nl80211_nan_publish_type. Its type is u8.
6119  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH_BCAST: relevant if the function is a solicited
6120  *	publish. Should the solicited publish Service Discovery Frame be sent to
6121  *	the NAN Broadcast address. This is a flag.
6122  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE_ACTIVE: relevant if the function's type is
6123  *	subscribe. Is the subscribe active. This is a flag.
6124  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_ID: relevant if the function's type is follow up.
6125  *	The instance ID for the follow up Service Discovery Frame. This is u8.
6126  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_REQ_ID: relevant if the function's type
6127  *	is follow up. This is a u8.
6128  *	The requestor instance ID for the follow up Service Discovery Frame.
6129  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_DEST: the MAC address of the recipient of the
6130  *	follow up Service Discovery Frame. This is a binary attribute.
6131  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_CLOSE_RANGE: is this function limited for devices in a
6132  *	close range. The range itself (RSSI) is defined by the device.
6133  *	This is a flag.
6134  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TTL: strictly positive number of DWs this function should
6135  *	stay active. If not present infinite TTL is assumed. This is a u32.
6136  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_INFO: array of bytes describing the service
6137  *	specific info. This is a binary attribute.
6138  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SRF: Service Receive Filter. This is a nested attribute.
6139  *	See &enum nl80211_nan_srf_attributes.
6140  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_RX_MATCH_FILTER: Receive Matching filter. This is a nested
6141  *	attribute. It is a list of binary values.
6142  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TX_MATCH_FILTER: Transmit Matching filter. This is a
6143  *	nested attribute. It is a list of binary values.
6144  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_INSTANCE_ID: The instance ID of the function.
6145  *	Its type is u8 and it cannot be 0.
6146  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON: NAN function termination reason.
6147  *	See &enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason.
6148  *
6149  * @NUM_NL80211_NAN_FUNC_ATTR: internal
6150  * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_ATTR_MAX: highest NAN function attribute
6151  */
6152 enum nl80211_nan_func_attributes {
6153 	__NL80211_NAN_FUNC_INVALID,
6154 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TYPE,
6155 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_ID,
6156 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH_TYPE,
6157 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH_BCAST,
6158 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE_ACTIVE,
6159 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_ID,
6160 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_REQ_ID,
6161 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_DEST,
6162 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_CLOSE_RANGE,
6163 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TTL,
6164 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_INFO,
6165 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SRF,
6166 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_RX_MATCH_FILTER,
6167 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TX_MATCH_FILTER,
6168 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_INSTANCE_ID,
6169 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON,
6170 
6171 	/* keep last */
6172 	NUM_NL80211_NAN_FUNC_ATTR,
6173 	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_NAN_FUNC_ATTR - 1
6174 };
6175 
6176 /**
6177  * enum nl80211_nan_srf_attributes - NAN Service Response filter attributes
6178  * @__NL80211_NAN_SRF_INVALID: invalid
6179  * @NL80211_NAN_SRF_INCLUDE: present if the include bit of the SRF set.
6180  *	This is a flag.
6181  * @NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF: Bloom Filter. Present if and only if
6182  *	%NL80211_NAN_SRF_MAC_ADDRS isn't present. This attribute is binary.
6183  * @NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF_IDX: index of the Bloom Filter. Mandatory if
6184  *	%NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF is present. This is a u8.
6185  * @NL80211_NAN_SRF_MAC_ADDRS: list of MAC addresses for the SRF. Present if
6186  *	and only if %NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF isn't present. This is a nested
6187  *	attribute. Each nested attribute is a MAC address.
6188  * @NUM_NL80211_NAN_SRF_ATTR: internal
6189  * @NL80211_NAN_SRF_ATTR_MAX: highest NAN SRF attribute
6190  */
6191 enum nl80211_nan_srf_attributes {
6192 	__NL80211_NAN_SRF_INVALID,
6193 	NL80211_NAN_SRF_INCLUDE,
6194 	NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF,
6195 	NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF_IDX,
6196 	NL80211_NAN_SRF_MAC_ADDRS,
6197 
6198 	/* keep last */
6199 	NUM_NL80211_NAN_SRF_ATTR,
6200 	NL80211_NAN_SRF_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_NAN_SRF_ATTR - 1,
6201 };
6202 
6203 /**
6204  * enum nl80211_nan_match_attributes - NAN match attributes
6205  * @__NL80211_NAN_MATCH_INVALID: invalid
6206  * @NL80211_NAN_MATCH_FUNC_LOCAL: the local function that had the
6207  *	match. This is a nested attribute.
6208  *	See &enum nl80211_nan_func_attributes.
6209  * @NL80211_NAN_MATCH_FUNC_PEER: the peer function
6210  *	that caused the match. This is a nested attribute.
6211  *	See &enum nl80211_nan_func_attributes.
6212  *
6213  * @NUM_NL80211_NAN_MATCH_ATTR: internal
6214  * @NL80211_NAN_MATCH_ATTR_MAX: highest NAN match attribute
6215  */
6216 enum nl80211_nan_match_attributes {
6217 	__NL80211_NAN_MATCH_INVALID,
6218 	NL80211_NAN_MATCH_FUNC_LOCAL,
6219 	NL80211_NAN_MATCH_FUNC_PEER,
6220 
6221 	/* keep last */
6222 	NUM_NL80211_NAN_MATCH_ATTR,
6223 	NL80211_NAN_MATCH_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_NAN_MATCH_ATTR - 1
6224 };
6225 
6226 /**
6227  * nl80211_external_auth_action - Action to perform with external
6228  *     authentication request. Used by NL80211_ATTR_EXTERNAL_AUTH_ACTION.
6229  * @NL80211_EXTERNAL_AUTH_START: Start the authentication.
6230  * @NL80211_EXTERNAL_AUTH_ABORT: Abort the ongoing authentication.
6231  */
6232 enum nl80211_external_auth_action {
6233 	NL80211_EXTERNAL_AUTH_START,
6234 	NL80211_EXTERNAL_AUTH_ABORT,
6235 };
6236 
6237 /**
6238  * enum nl80211_ftm_responder_attributes - fine timing measurement
6239  *	responder attributes
6240  * @__NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
6241  * @NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_ENABLED: FTM responder is enabled
6242  * @NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LCI: The content of Measurement Report Element
6243  *	(9.4.2.22 in 802.11-2016) with type 8 - LCI (9.4.2.22.10),
6244  *	i.e. starting with the measurement token
6245  * @NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_CIVIC: The content of Measurement Report Element
6246  *	(9.4.2.22 in 802.11-2016) with type 11 - Civic (Section 9.4.2.22.13),
6247  *	i.e. starting with the measurement token
6248  * @__NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LAST: Internal
6249  * @NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_MAX: highest FTM responder attribute.
6250  */
6251 enum nl80211_ftm_responder_attributes {
6252 	__NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_INVALID,
6253 
6254 	NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_ENABLED,
6255 	NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LCI,
6256 	NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_CIVICLOC,
6257 
6258 	/* keep last */
6259 	__NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LAST,
6260 	NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LAST - 1,
6261 };
6262 
6263 /*
6264  * enum nl80211_ftm_responder_stats - FTM responder statistics
6265  *
6266  * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS
6267  * when getting FTM responder statistics.
6268  *
6269  * @__NL80211_FTM_STATS_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
6270  * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_SUCCESS_NUM: number of FTM sessions in which all frames
6271  *	were ssfully answered (u32)
6272  * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_PARTIAL_NUM: number of FTM sessions in which part of the
6273  *	frames were successfully answered (u32)
6274  * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_FAILED_NUM: number of failed FTM sessions (u32)
6275  * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_ASAP_NUM: number of ASAP sessions (u32)
6276  * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_NON_ASAP_NUM: number of non-ASAP sessions (u32)
6277  * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_TOTAL_DURATION_MSEC: total sessions durations - gives an
6278  *	indication of how much time the responder was busy (u64, msec)
6279  * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_UNKNOWN_TRIGGERS_NUM: number of unknown FTM triggers -
6280  *	triggers from initiators that didn't finish successfully the negotiation
6281  *	phase with the responder (u32)
6282  * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_RESCHEDULE_REQUESTS_NUM: number of FTM reschedule requests
6283  *	- initiator asks for a new scheduling although it already has scheduled
6284  *	FTM slot (u32)
6285  * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_OUT_OF_WINDOW_TRIGGERS_NUM: number of FTM triggers out of
6286  *	scheduled window (u32)
6287  * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_PAD: used for padding, ignore
6288  * @__NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: Internal
6289  * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_MAX: highest possible FTM responder stats attribute
6290  */
6291 enum nl80211_ftm_responder_stats {
6292 	__NL80211_FTM_STATS_INVALID,
6293 	NL80211_FTM_STATS_SUCCESS_NUM,
6294 	NL80211_FTM_STATS_PARTIAL_NUM,
6295 	NL80211_FTM_STATS_FAILED_NUM,
6296 	NL80211_FTM_STATS_ASAP_NUM,
6297 	NL80211_FTM_STATS_NON_ASAP_NUM,
6298 	NL80211_FTM_STATS_TOTAL_DURATION_MSEC,
6299 	NL80211_FTM_STATS_UNKNOWN_TRIGGERS_NUM,
6300 	NL80211_FTM_STATS_RESCHEDULE_REQUESTS_NUM,
6301 	NL80211_FTM_STATS_OUT_OF_WINDOW_TRIGGERS_NUM,
6302 	NL80211_FTM_STATS_PAD,
6303 
6304 	/* keep last */
6305 	__NL80211_FTM_STATS_AFTER_LAST,
6306 	NL80211_FTM_STATS_MAX = __NL80211_FTM_STATS_AFTER_LAST - 1
6307 };
6308 
6309 /**
6310  * enum nl80211_preamble - frame preamble types
6311  * @NL80211_PREAMBLE_LEGACY: legacy (HR/DSSS, OFDM, ERP PHY) preamble
6312  * @NL80211_PREAMBLE_HT: HT preamble
6313  * @NL80211_PREAMBLE_VHT: VHT preamble
6314  * @NL80211_PREAMBLE_DMG: DMG preamble
6315  */
6316 enum nl80211_preamble {
6317 	NL80211_PREAMBLE_LEGACY,
6318 	NL80211_PREAMBLE_HT,
6319 	NL80211_PREAMBLE_VHT,
6320 	NL80211_PREAMBLE_DMG,
6321 };
6322 
6323 /**
6324  * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_type - peer measurement types
6325  * @NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_INVALID: invalid/unused, needed as we use
6326  *	these numbers also for attributes
6327  *
6328  * @NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_FTM: flight time measurement
6329  *
6330  * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_TYPES: internal
6331  * @NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_MAX: highest type number
6332  */
6333 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_type {
6334 	NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_INVALID,
6335 
6336 	NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_FTM,
6337 
6338 	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_TYPES,
6339 	NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_TYPES - 1
6340 };
6341 
6342 /**
6343  * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_status - peer measurement status
6344  * @NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_SUCCESS: measurement completed successfully
6345  * @NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_REFUSED: measurement was locally refused
6346  * @NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_TIMEOUT: measurement timed out
6347  * @NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_FAILURE: measurement failed, a type-dependent
6348  *	reason may be available in the response data
6349  */
6350 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_status {
6351 	NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_SUCCESS,
6352 	NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_REFUSED,
6353 	NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_TIMEOUT,
6354 	NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_FAILURE,
6355 };
6356 
6357 /**
6358  * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_req - peer measurement request attributes
6359  * @__NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_INVALID: invalid
6360  *
6361  * @NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_DATA: This is a nested attribute with measurement
6362  *	type-specific request data inside. The attributes used are from the
6363  *	enums named nl80211_peer_measurement_<type>_req.
6364  * @NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_GET_AP_TSF: include AP TSF timestamp, if supported
6365  *	(flag attribute)
6366  *
6367  * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTRS: internal
6368  * @NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number
6369  */
6370 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_req {
6371 	__NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_INVALID,
6372 
6373 	NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_DATA,
6374 	NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_GET_AP_TSF,
6375 
6376 	/* keep last */
6377 	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTRS,
6378 	NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTRS - 1
6379 };
6380 
6381 /**
6382  * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_resp - peer measurement response attributes
6383  * @__NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_INVALID: invalid
6384  *
6385  * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_DATA: This is a nested attribute with measurement
6386  *	type-specific results inside. The attributes used are from the enums
6387  *	named nl80211_peer_measurement_<type>_resp.
6388  * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_STATUS: u32 value with the measurement status
6389  *	(using values from &enum nl80211_peer_measurement_status.)
6390  * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_HOST_TIME: host time (%CLOCK_BOOTTIME) when the
6391  *	result was measured; this value is not expected to be accurate to
6392  *	more than 20ms. (u64, nanoseconds)
6393  * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_AP_TSF: TSF of the AP that the interface
6394  *	doing the measurement is connected to when the result was measured.
6395  *	This shall be accurately reported if supported and requested
6396  *	(u64, usec)
6397  * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_FINAL: If results are sent to the host partially
6398  *	(*e.g. with FTM per-burst data) this flag will be cleared on all but
6399  *	the last result; if all results are combined it's set on the single
6400  *	result.
6401  * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_PAD: padding for 64-bit attributes, ignore
6402  *
6403  * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTRS: internal
6404  * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number
6405  */
6406 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_resp {
6407 	__NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_INVALID,
6408 
6409 	NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_DATA,
6410 	NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_STATUS,
6411 	NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_HOST_TIME,
6412 	NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_AP_TSF,
6413 	NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_FINAL,
6414 	NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_PAD,
6415 
6416 	/* keep last */
6417 	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTRS,
6418 	NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTRS - 1
6419 };
6420 
6421 /**
6422  * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_peer_attrs - peer attributes for measurement
6423  * @__NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_INVALID: invalid
6424  *
6425  * @NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_ADDR: peer's MAC address
6426  * @NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_CHAN: channel definition, nested, using top-level
6427  *	attributes like %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ etc.
6428  * @NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_REQ: This is a nested attribute indexed by
6429  *	measurement type, with attributes from the
6430  *	&enum nl80211_peer_measurement_req inside.
6431  * @NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_RESP: This is a nested attribute indexed by
6432  *	measurement type, with attributes from the
6433  *	&enum nl80211_peer_measurement_resp inside.
6434  *
6435  * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTRS: internal
6436  * @NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number
6437  */
6438 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_peer_attrs {
6439 	__NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_INVALID,
6440 
6441 	NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_ADDR,
6442 	NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_CHAN,
6443 	NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_REQ,
6444 	NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_RESP,
6445 
6446 	/* keep last */
6447 	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTRS,
6448 	NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTRS - 1,
6449 };
6450 
6451 /**
6452  * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_attrs - peer measurement attributes
6453  * @__NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_INVALID: invalid
6454  *
6455  * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_MAX_PEERS: u32 attribute used for capability
6456  *	advertisement only, indicates the maximum number of peers
6457  *	measurements can be done with in a single request
6458  * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_REPORT_AP_TSF: flag attribute in capability
6459  *	indicating that the connected AP's TSF can be reported in
6460  *	measurement results
6461  * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_RANDOMIZE_MAC_ADDR: flag attribute in capability
6462  *	indicating that MAC address randomization is supported.
6463  * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_TYPE_CAPA: capabilities reported by the device,
6464  *	this contains a nesting indexed by measurement type, and
6465  *	type-specific capabilities inside, which are from the enums
6466  *	named nl80211_peer_measurement_<type>_capa.
6467  * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_PEERS: nested attribute, the nesting index is
6468  *	meaningless, just a list of peers to measure with, with the
6469  *	sub-attributes taken from
6470  *	&enum nl80211_peer_measurement_peer_attrs.
6471  *
6472  * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_ATTR: internal
6473  * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number
6474  */
6475 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_attrs {
6476 	__NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_INVALID,
6477 
6478 	NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_MAX_PEERS,
6479 	NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_REPORT_AP_TSF,
6480 	NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_RANDOMIZE_MAC_ADDR,
6481 	NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_TYPE_CAPA,
6482 	NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_PEERS,
6483 
6484 	/* keep last */
6485 	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_ATTR,
6486 	NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_ATTR - 1
6487 };
6488 
6489 /**
6490  * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_capa - FTM capabilities
6491  * @__NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_INVALID: invalid
6492  *
6493  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_ASAP: flag attribute indicating ASAP mode
6494  *	is supported
6495  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_NON_ASAP: flag attribute indicating non-ASAP
6496  *	mode is supported
6497  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_REQ_LCI: flag attribute indicating if LCI
6498  *	data can be requested during the measurement
6499  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_REQ_CIVICLOC: flag attribute indicating if civic
6500  *	location data can be requested during the measurement
6501  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_PREAMBLES: u32 bitmap attribute of bits
6502  *	from &enum nl80211_preamble.
6503  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_BANDWIDTHS: bitmap of values from
6504  *	&enum nl80211_chan_width indicating the supported channel
6505  *	bandwidths for FTM. Note that a higher channel bandwidth may be
6506  *	configured to allow for other measurements types with different
6507  *	bandwidth requirement in the same measurement.
6508  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX_BURSTS_EXPONENT: u32 attribute indicating
6509  *	the maximum bursts exponent that can be used (if not present anything
6510  *	is valid)
6511  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX_FTMS_PER_BURST: u32 attribute indicating
6512  *	the maximum FTMs per burst (if not present anything is valid)
6513  *
6514  * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR: internal
6515  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number
6516  */
6517 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_capa {
6518 	__NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_INVALID,
6519 
6520 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_ASAP,
6521 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_NON_ASAP,
6522 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_REQ_LCI,
6523 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_REQ_CIVICLOC,
6524 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_PREAMBLES,
6525 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_BANDWIDTHS,
6526 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX_BURSTS_EXPONENT,
6527 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX_FTMS_PER_BURST,
6528 
6529 	/* keep last */
6530 	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR,
6531 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR - 1
6532 };
6533 
6534 /**
6535  * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_req - FTM request attributes
6536  * @__NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_INVALID: invalid
6537  *
6538  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_ASAP: ASAP mode requested (flag)
6539  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_PREAMBLE: preamble type (see
6540  *	&enum nl80211_preamble), optional for DMG (u32)
6541  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NUM_BURSTS_EXP: number of bursts exponent as in
6542  *	802.11-2016 9.4.2.168 "Fine Timing Measurement Parameters element"
6543  *	(u8, 0-15, optional with default 15 i.e. "no preference")
6544  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_BURST_PERIOD: interval between bursts in units
6545  *	of 100ms (u16, optional with default 0)
6546  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_BURST_DURATION: burst duration, as in 802.11-2016
6547  *	Table 9-257 "Burst Duration field encoding" (u8, 0-15, optional with
6548  *	default 15 i.e. "no preference")
6549  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_FTMS_PER_BURST: number of successful FTM frames
6550  *	requested per burst
6551  *	(u8, 0-31, optional with default 0 i.e. "no preference")
6552  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_RETRIES: number of FTMR frame retries
6553  *	(u8, default 3)
6554  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_REQUEST_LCI: request LCI data (flag)
6555  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_REQUEST_CIVICLOC: request civic location data
6556  *	(flag)
6557  *
6558  * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR: internal
6559  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number
6560  */
6561 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_req {
6562 	__NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_INVALID,
6563 
6564 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_ASAP,
6565 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_PREAMBLE,
6566 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NUM_BURSTS_EXP,
6567 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_BURST_PERIOD,
6568 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_BURST_DURATION,
6569 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_FTMS_PER_BURST,
6570 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_RETRIES,
6571 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_REQUEST_LCI,
6572 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_REQUEST_CIVICLOC,
6573 
6574 	/* keep last */
6575 	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR,
6576 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR - 1
6577 };
6578 
6579 /**
6580  * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_failure_reasons - FTM failure reasons
6581  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_UNSPECIFIED: unspecified failure, not used
6582  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_NO_RESPONSE: no response from the FTM responder
6583  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_REJECTED: FTM responder rejected measurement
6584  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_WRONG_CHANNEL: we already know the peer is
6585  *	on a different channel, so can't measure (if we didn't know, we'd
6586  *	try and get no response)
6587  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_NOT_CAPABLE: peer can't actually do FTM
6588  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_INVALID_TIMESTAMP: invalid T1/T4 timestamps
6589  *	received
6590  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_BUSY: peer reports busy, you may retry
6591  *	later (see %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BUSY_RETRY_TIME)
6592  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_BAD_CHANGED_PARAMS: parameters were changed
6593  *	by the peer and are no longer supported
6594  */
6595 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_failure_reasons {
6596 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_UNSPECIFIED,
6597 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_NO_RESPONSE,
6598 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_REJECTED,
6599 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_WRONG_CHANNEL,
6600 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_NOT_CAPABLE,
6601 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_INVALID_TIMESTAMP,
6602 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_BUSY,
6603 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_BAD_CHANGED_PARAMS,
6604 };
6605 
6606 /**
6607  * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_resp - FTM response attributes
6608  * @__NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_INVALID: invalid
6609  *
6610  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_FAIL_REASON: FTM-specific failure reason
6611  *	(u32, optional)
6612  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BURST_INDEX: optional, if bursts are reported
6613  *	as separate results then it will be the burst index 0...(N-1) and
6614  *	the top level will indicate partial results (u32)
6615  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_ATTEMPTS: number of FTM Request frames
6616  *	transmitted (u32, optional)
6617  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_SUCCESSES: number of FTM Request frames
6618  *	that were acknowleged (u32, optional)
6619  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BUSY_RETRY_TIME: retry time received from the
6620  *	busy peer (u32, seconds)
6621  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_BURSTS_EXP: actual number of bursts exponent
6622  *	used by the responder (similar to request, u8)
6623  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BURST_DURATION: actual burst duration used by
6624  *	the responder (similar to request, u8)
6625  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_FTMS_PER_BURST: actual FTMs per burst used
6626  *	by the responder (similar to request, u8)
6627  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RSSI_AVG: average RSSI across all FTM action
6628  *	frames (optional, s32, 1/2 dBm)
6629  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RSSI_SPREAD: RSSI spread across all FTM action
6630  *	frames (optional, s32, 1/2 dBm)
6631  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_TX_RATE: bitrate we used for the response to the
6632  *	FTM action frame (optional, nested, using &enum nl80211_rate_info
6633  *	attributes)
6634  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RX_RATE: bitrate the responder used for the FTM
6635  *	action frame (optional, nested, using &enum nl80211_rate_info attrs)
6636  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_AVG: average RTT (s64, picoseconds, optional
6637  *	but one of RTT/DIST must be present)
6638  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_VARIANCE: RTT variance (u64, ps^2, note that
6639  *	standard deviation is the square root of variance, optional)
6640  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_SPREAD: RTT spread (u64, picoseconds,
6641  *	optional)
6642  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_AVG: average distance (s64, mm, optional
6643  *	but one of RTT/DIST must be present)
6644  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_VARIANCE: distance variance (u64, mm^2, note
6645  *	that standard deviation is the square root of variance, optional)
6646  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_SPREAD: distance spread (u64, mm, optional)
6647  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LCI: LCI data from peer (binary, optional);
6648  *	this is the contents of the Measurement Report Element (802.11-2016
6649  *	9.4.2.22.1) starting with the Measurement Token, with Measurement
6650  *	Type 8.
6651  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_CIVICLOC: civic location data from peer
6652  *	(binary, optional);
6653  *	this is the contents of the Measurement Report Element (802.11-2016
6654  *	9.4.2.22.1) starting with the Measurement Token, with Measurement
6655  *	Type 11.
6656  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_PAD: ignore, for u64/s64 padding only
6657  *
6658  * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR: internal
6659  * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number
6660  */
6661 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_resp {
6662 	__NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_INVALID,
6663 
6664 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_FAIL_REASON,
6665 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BURST_INDEX,
6666 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_ATTEMPTS,
6667 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_SUCCESSES,
6668 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BUSY_RETRY_TIME,
6669 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_BURSTS_EXP,
6670 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BURST_DURATION,
6671 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_FTMS_PER_BURST,
6672 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RSSI_AVG,
6673 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RSSI_SPREAD,
6674 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_TX_RATE,
6675 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RX_RATE,
6676 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_AVG,
6677 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_VARIANCE,
6678 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_SPREAD,
6679 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_AVG,
6680 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_VARIANCE,
6681 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_SPREAD,
6682 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LCI,
6683 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_CIVICLOC,
6684 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_PAD,
6685 
6686 	/* keep last */
6687 	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR,
6688 	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR - 1
6689 };
6690 
6691 /**
6692  * enum nl80211_obss_pd_attributes - OBSS packet detection attributes
6693  * @__NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
6694  *
6695  * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MIN_OFFSET: the OBSS PD minimum tx power offset.
6696  * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MAX_OFFSET: the OBSS PD maximum tx power offset.
6697  *
6698  * @__NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_LAST: Internal
6699  * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MAX: highest OBSS PD attribute.
6700  */
6701 enum nl80211_obss_pd_attributes {
6702 	__NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_INVALID,
6703 
6704 	NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MIN_OFFSET,
6705 	NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MAX_OFFSET,
6706 
6707 	/* keep last */
6708 	__NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_LAST,
6709 	NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_LAST - 1,
6710 };
6711 
6712 /**
6713  * enum nl80211_bss_color_attributes - BSS Color attributes
6714  * @__NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
6715  *
6716  * @NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_COLOR: the current BSS Color.
6717  * @NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_DISABLED: is BSS coloring disabled.
6718  * @NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_PARTIAL: the AID equation to be used..
6719  *
6720  * @__NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_LAST: Internal
6721  * @NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_MAX: highest BSS Color attribute.
6722  */
6723 enum nl80211_bss_color_attributes {
6724 	__NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_INVALID,
6725 
6726 	NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_COLOR,
6727 	NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_DISABLED,
6728 	NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_PARTIAL,
6729 
6730 	/* keep last */
6731 	__NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_LAST,
6732 	NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_LAST - 1,
6733 };
6734 
6735 /**
6736  * enum nl80211_iftype_akm_attributes - interface type AKM attributes
6737  * @__NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
6738  *
6739  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_IFTYPES: nested attribute containing a flag
6740  *	attribute for each interface type that supports AKM suites specified in
6741  *	%NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_SUITES
6742  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_SUITES: an array of u32. Used to indicate supported
6743  *	AKM suites for the specified interface types.
6744  *
6745  * @__NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_LAST: Internal
6746  * @NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_MAX: highest interface type AKM attribute.
6747  */
6748 enum nl80211_iftype_akm_attributes {
6749 	__NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_INVALID,
6750 
6751 	NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_IFTYPES,
6752 	NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_SUITES,
6753 
6754 	/* keep last */
6755 	__NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_LAST,
6756 	NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_LAST - 1,
6757 };
6758 
6759 #endif /* __LINUX_NL80211_H */
6760